3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
10 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
15 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
16 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
17 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
18 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
19 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
20 License'' in the Emacs manual.
22 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
23 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
24 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
26 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
27 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
28 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
29 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
35 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
36 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
37 \usepackage{pagestyle}
40 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
42 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
44 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
52 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
53 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.11}
54 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
55 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
57 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
59 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
60 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
61 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
65 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
68 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
78 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
96 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
98 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
99 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
100 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
101 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
104 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
110 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
111 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
112 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
115 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
117 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
121 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
124 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
126 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
128 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
129 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
130 \thispagestyle{empty}
132 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
133 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
134 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
139 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
141 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
148 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
149 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
152 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
156 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
157 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
160 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
161 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
164 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
166 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
167 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
171 \newenvironment{codelist}%
176 \newenvironment{asislist}%
181 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
187 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
192 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
197 \newenvironment{samplist}%
202 \newenvironment{varlist}%
207 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
212 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
213 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
214 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
216 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
221 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
225 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
234 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
241 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
246 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
250 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
258 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
274 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
282 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
289 \pagenumbering{roman}
290 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
301 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
302 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
304 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
306 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
309 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
312 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
319 \thispagestyle{empty}
333 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
338 @setchapternewpage odd
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
347 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
353 @top The Gnus Newsreader
357 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
358 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
359 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
362 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
363 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.11.
374 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
375 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
377 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
378 being accused of plagiarism:
380 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
381 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
382 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
383 can even read news with it!
385 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
386 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
387 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
388 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
389 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
395 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
396 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
397 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
398 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
399 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
400 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
401 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
402 * Various:: General purpose settings.
403 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
404 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
405 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
406 * Key Index:: Key Index.
408 Other related manuals
410 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
411 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
412 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
413 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
416 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
420 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
421 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
422 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
423 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
424 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
425 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
426 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
427 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
428 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
429 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
430 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
434 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
435 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
436 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
440 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
441 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
442 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
443 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
444 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
445 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
446 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
447 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
448 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
449 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
450 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
451 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
452 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
453 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
454 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
455 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
456 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
460 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
461 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
462 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
466 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
467 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
468 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
469 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
470 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
474 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
475 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
476 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
477 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
478 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
482 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
483 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
484 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
485 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
486 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
487 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
488 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
489 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
490 * Threading:: How threads are made.
491 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
492 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
493 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
494 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
495 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
496 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
497 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
498 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
499 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
500 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
501 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
502 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
503 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
504 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
505 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
506 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
507 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
508 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
509 or reselecting the current group.
510 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
511 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
512 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
513 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
515 Summary Buffer Format
517 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
518 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
519 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
520 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
524 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
525 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
527 Reply, Followup and Post
529 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
530 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
531 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
532 * Canceling and Superseding::
536 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
537 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
538 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
539 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
540 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
541 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
545 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
546 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
548 Customizing Threading
550 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
551 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
552 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
553 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
557 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
558 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
559 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
560 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
561 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
562 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
566 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
567 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
568 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
572 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
573 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
574 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
575 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
576 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
577 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
578 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
579 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
580 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
581 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
582 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
584 Alternative Approaches
586 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
587 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
589 Various Summary Stuff
591 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
592 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
593 * Summary Generation Commands::
594 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
598 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
599 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
600 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
601 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
602 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
606 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
607 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
608 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
609 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
610 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
611 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
612 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
613 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
614 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
618 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
619 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
620 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
621 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
622 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
623 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
624 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
625 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
629 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
630 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
631 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
632 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
633 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
634 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
635 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
639 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
640 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
644 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
645 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
646 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
650 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
651 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
652 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
653 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
654 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
655 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
656 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
657 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
658 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
659 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
660 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
661 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
662 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
666 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
667 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
668 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
670 Choosing a Mail Back End
672 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
673 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
674 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
675 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
676 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
677 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
678 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
683 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
684 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
685 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
686 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
687 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
688 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
692 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
693 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
694 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
695 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
696 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
697 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
701 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
702 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
703 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
704 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
705 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
709 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
713 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
714 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
715 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
719 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
720 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
724 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
725 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
726 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
727 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
728 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
729 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
730 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
731 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
732 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
733 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
734 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
735 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
736 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
740 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
741 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
742 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
746 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
747 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
748 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
752 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
753 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
754 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
755 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
756 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
757 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
758 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
759 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
760 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
761 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
762 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
763 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
764 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
765 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
766 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
767 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
768 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
772 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
773 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
774 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
775 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
779 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
780 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
781 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
785 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
786 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
787 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
788 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
789 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
790 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
791 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
792 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
793 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
794 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
795 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
796 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
797 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
798 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
799 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
800 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
801 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
802 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
803 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
804 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
808 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
809 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
810 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
811 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
812 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
813 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
814 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
815 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
819 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
820 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
821 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
822 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
823 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
827 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
828 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
829 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
830 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
831 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
832 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
834 Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
836 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
837 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
838 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
839 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
840 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
842 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
843 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
845 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
847 * ifile spam filtering::
848 * spam-stat spam filtering::
850 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
852 Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
854 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
855 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
856 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
860 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
861 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
862 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
863 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
864 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
865 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
866 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
867 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
868 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
872 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
873 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
874 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
875 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
876 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
877 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
878 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
879 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
880 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
884 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
885 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
886 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
887 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
888 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
889 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
893 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
894 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
895 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
896 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
900 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
901 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
902 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
903 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
904 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
905 * Group Info:: The group info format.
906 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
907 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
908 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
912 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
913 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
914 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
915 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
916 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
917 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
921 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
922 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
926 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
927 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
933 @chapter Starting Gnus
938 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
939 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
942 @findex gnus-other-frame
943 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
944 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
945 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
947 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
948 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
949 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
951 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
952 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
955 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
956 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
957 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
958 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
959 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
960 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
961 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
962 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
963 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
964 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
968 @node Finding the News
969 @section Finding the News
972 @vindex gnus-select-method
974 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
975 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
976 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
977 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
980 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
981 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
984 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
987 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
990 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
993 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
994 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
995 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
996 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
998 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1000 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1001 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1002 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1003 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1004 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1005 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1006 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1008 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1009 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1010 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1011 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1013 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1014 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1015 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1016 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1017 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1018 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1019 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1020 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1021 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1024 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1026 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1027 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1028 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1029 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1030 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1031 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1033 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1035 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1036 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1037 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1038 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1039 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1040 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1043 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1044 you would typically set this variable to
1047 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1051 @node The First Time
1052 @section The First Time
1053 @cindex first time usage
1055 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1056 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1058 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1059 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1060 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1061 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1064 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1065 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1066 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1068 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1069 help you with most common problems.
1071 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1072 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1076 @node The Server is Down
1077 @section The Server is Down
1078 @cindex server errors
1080 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1081 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1082 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1084 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1085 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1086 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1087 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1088 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1089 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1090 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1092 @findex gnus-no-server
1093 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1095 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1096 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1097 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1098 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1099 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1100 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1101 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1105 @section Slave Gnusae
1108 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1109 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1110 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1111 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1113 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1114 @file{.newsrc} file.
1116 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1117 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1118 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1119 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1120 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1121 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1122 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1125 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1126 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1127 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1128 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1129 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1130 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1131 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1132 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1134 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1135 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1137 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1138 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1139 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1140 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1141 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1148 @cindex subscription
1150 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1151 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1152 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1153 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1154 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1155 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1156 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1157 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1158 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1161 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1162 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1163 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1167 @node Checking New Groups
1168 @subsection Checking New Groups
1170 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1171 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1172 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1173 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1174 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1175 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1176 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1177 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1178 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1179 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1181 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1182 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1183 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1184 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1185 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1186 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1187 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1188 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1189 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1190 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1191 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1193 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1194 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1195 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1196 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1197 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1198 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1201 @node Subscription Methods
1202 @subsection Subscription Methods
1204 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1205 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1206 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1208 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1209 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1211 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1215 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1216 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1217 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1218 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1219 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1221 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1222 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1223 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1224 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1226 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1227 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1228 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1230 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1231 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1232 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1233 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1234 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1235 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1236 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1237 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1238 up. Or something like that.
1240 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1241 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1242 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1243 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1244 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1246 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1247 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1248 Kill all new groups.
1250 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1251 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1252 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1253 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1254 topic parameter that looks like
1260 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1263 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1268 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1269 A closely related variable is
1270 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1271 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1272 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1273 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1276 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1277 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1278 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1279 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1282 @node Filtering New Groups
1283 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1285 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1286 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1287 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1290 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1293 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1294 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1295 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1296 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1297 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1298 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1299 subscribing these groups.
1300 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1301 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1303 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1304 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1305 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1306 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1307 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1308 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1309 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1310 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1312 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1313 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1314 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1315 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1316 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1317 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1318 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1319 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1320 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1321 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1324 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1325 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1328 @node Changing Servers
1329 @section Changing Servers
1330 @cindex changing servers
1332 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1333 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1334 very flaky and you want to use another.
1336 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1337 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1341 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1342 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1343 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1344 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1347 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1348 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1349 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1350 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1352 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1353 @findex gnus-change-server
1354 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1355 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1356 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1357 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1358 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1360 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1361 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1362 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1363 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1364 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1366 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1367 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1368 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1369 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1370 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1371 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1373 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1374 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1375 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1376 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1378 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1379 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1380 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1381 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1382 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1383 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1384 cache for all groups).
1388 @section Startup Files
1389 @cindex startup files
1394 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1395 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1396 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1399 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1400 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1401 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1402 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1403 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1404 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1405 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1407 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1408 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1409 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1410 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1411 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1412 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1414 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1415 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1416 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1417 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1418 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1419 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1420 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1421 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1422 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1423 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1424 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1427 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1428 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1429 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1430 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1431 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1432 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1433 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1434 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1435 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1436 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1437 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1438 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1440 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1441 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1442 @vindex version-control
1443 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1444 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1445 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1446 If you want version control for this file, set
1447 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1448 @code{version-control} variable.
1450 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1451 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1452 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1453 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1454 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1455 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1456 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1457 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1458 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1459 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1462 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1463 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1465 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1466 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1469 @vindex gnus-init-file
1470 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1471 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1472 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1473 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1474 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1475 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1476 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1477 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1478 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1479 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1480 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1481 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1482 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1487 @cindex dribble file
1490 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1491 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1492 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1493 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1494 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1497 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1498 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1501 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1502 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1503 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1505 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1506 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1507 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1508 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1509 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1510 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1512 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1513 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1514 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1517 @node The Active File
1518 @section The Active File
1520 @cindex ignored groups
1522 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1523 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1524 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1526 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1527 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1528 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1529 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1530 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1531 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1532 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1535 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1536 @c if you set it to anything else.
1538 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1540 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1541 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1542 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1544 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1545 you actually subscribe to.
1547 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1548 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1549 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1550 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1552 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1553 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1554 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1555 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1556 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1557 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1559 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1560 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1561 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1564 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1565 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1566 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1567 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1568 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1569 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1571 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1572 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1574 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1575 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1577 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1578 secondary select methods.
1581 @node Startup Variables
1582 @section Startup Variables
1586 @item gnus-load-hook
1587 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1588 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1589 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1590 times you start Gnus.
1592 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1593 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1594 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1596 @item gnus-startup-hook
1597 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1598 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1600 @item gnus-started-hook
1601 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1602 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1605 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1606 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1607 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1608 generating the group buffer.
1610 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1611 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1612 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1613 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1614 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1615 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1616 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1617 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1619 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1620 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1621 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1622 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1623 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1624 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1626 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1627 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1628 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1630 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1631 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1632 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1634 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1635 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1636 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1637 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1643 @chapter Group Buffer
1644 @cindex group buffer
1646 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1648 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1649 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1650 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1651 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1652 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1653 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1654 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1655 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1656 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1657 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1658 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1659 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1660 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1661 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1662 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1663 @c human rights at 9...
1666 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1667 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1668 long as Gnus is active.
1672 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1673 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1674 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1675 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1676 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1677 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1678 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1679 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1685 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1686 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1687 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1688 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1689 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1690 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1691 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1692 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1693 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1694 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1695 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1696 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1697 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1698 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1699 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1700 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1701 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1705 @node Group Buffer Format
1706 @section Group Buffer Format
1709 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1710 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1711 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1715 @node Group Line Specification
1716 @subsection Group Line Specification
1717 @cindex group buffer format
1719 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1720 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1722 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1725 25: news.announce.newusers
1726 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1731 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1732 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1733 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1734 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1736 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1737 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1738 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1739 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1740 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1741 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1743 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1745 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1746 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1747 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1748 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1749 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1751 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1752 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1753 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1755 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1760 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1763 Whether the group is subscribed.
1766 Level of subscribedness.
1769 Number of unread articles.
1772 Number of dormant articles.
1775 Number of ticked articles.
1778 Number of read articles.
1781 Number of unseen articles.
1784 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1785 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1787 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1788 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1789 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1790 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1791 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1792 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1793 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1794 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1797 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1800 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1809 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1810 comment element in the group parameters.
1813 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1814 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1815 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1819 @samp{m} if moderated.
1822 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1828 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1834 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1838 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1841 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1842 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1843 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1844 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1845 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1848 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1850 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1854 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1857 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1861 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1862 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1863 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1864 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1865 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1866 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1871 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1872 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1873 group, or a bogus native group.
1876 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1877 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1878 @cindex group mode line
1880 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1881 The mode line can be changed by setting
1882 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1883 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1887 The native news server.
1889 The native select method.
1893 @node Group Highlighting
1894 @subsection Group Highlighting
1895 @cindex highlighting
1896 @cindex group highlighting
1898 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1899 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1900 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1901 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1902 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1904 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1908 (cond (window-system
1909 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1910 (defface my-group-face-1
1911 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1912 (defface my-group-face-2
1913 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1914 "Second group face")
1915 (defface my-group-face-3
1916 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1917 (defface my-group-face-4
1918 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1919 (defface my-group-face-5
1920 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1922 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1923 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1924 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1925 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1926 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1927 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1930 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1932 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1939 The number of unread articles in the group.
1943 Whether the group is a mail group.
1945 The level of the group.
1947 The score of the group.
1949 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1951 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1952 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1954 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1955 topic being inserted.
1958 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1959 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1960 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1962 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1963 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1964 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1965 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1966 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1969 @node Group Maneuvering
1970 @section Group Maneuvering
1971 @cindex group movement
1973 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1974 expected, hopefully.
1980 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1981 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1982 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1988 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1989 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1990 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1994 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1995 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1999 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2000 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2004 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2005 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2006 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2010 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2011 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2012 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2015 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2021 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2022 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2023 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2028 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2029 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2030 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2034 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2035 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2036 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2039 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2040 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2041 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2042 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2046 @node Selecting a Group
2047 @section Selecting a Group
2048 @cindex group selection
2053 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2054 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2055 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2056 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2057 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2058 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2059 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2060 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2061 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2062 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2064 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2065 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2066 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2068 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2069 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2074 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2075 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2076 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2077 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2078 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2082 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2083 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2084 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2085 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2086 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2087 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2088 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2089 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2090 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2091 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2094 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2095 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2096 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2097 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2098 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2101 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2102 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2103 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2104 doing any processing of its contents
2105 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2106 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2107 manner will have no permanent effects.
2111 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2112 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2113 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2114 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2115 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2116 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2117 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2118 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2119 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2120 most recently will be fetched.
2122 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2123 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2124 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2127 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2128 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2129 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2130 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2131 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2132 Which article this is is controlled by the
2133 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2139 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2142 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2145 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2147 @item unseen-or-unread
2148 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2149 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2153 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2157 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2158 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2160 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2161 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2162 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2163 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2167 @node Subscription Commands
2168 @section Subscription Commands
2169 @cindex subscription
2177 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2178 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2179 Toggle subscription to the current group
2180 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2186 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2187 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2188 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2189 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2195 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2196 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2197 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2203 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2204 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2207 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2208 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2209 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2210 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2211 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2217 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2218 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2222 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2223 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2226 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2227 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2228 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2229 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2230 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2231 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2232 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2233 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2234 @file{.newsrc} file.
2238 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2248 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2249 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2250 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2251 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2252 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2253 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2258 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2259 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2260 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2264 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2265 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2266 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2268 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2269 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2270 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2271 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2272 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2273 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2280 @section Group Levels
2284 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2285 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2286 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2287 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2288 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2290 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2296 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2297 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2298 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2299 prompted for a level.
2302 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2303 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2304 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2305 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2306 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2307 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2308 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2309 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2310 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2311 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2312 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2313 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2314 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2315 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2316 reasons of efficiency.
2318 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2319 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2321 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2322 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2323 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2324 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2325 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2326 groups are hidden, in a way.
2328 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2329 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2330 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2331 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2332 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2333 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2335 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2336 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2337 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2338 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2339 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2340 list of killed groups.)
2342 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2343 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2344 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2346 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2347 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2348 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2349 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2350 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2351 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2352 relevant valid ranges.
2354 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2355 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2356 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2357 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2358 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2359 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2362 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2363 one with the best level.
2365 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2366 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2367 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2370 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2371 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2372 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2373 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2376 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2377 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2378 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2379 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2381 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2382 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2383 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2384 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2385 to 5. The default is 6.
2389 @section Group Score
2394 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2395 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2396 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2399 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2400 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2401 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2402 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2403 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2404 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2405 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2406 least significant part.))
2408 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2409 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2410 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2411 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2412 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2413 action after each summary exit, you can add
2414 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2415 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2416 slow things down somewhat.
2419 @node Marking Groups
2420 @section Marking Groups
2421 @cindex marking groups
2423 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2424 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2425 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2426 bidding on those groups.
2428 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2429 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2430 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2438 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2439 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2445 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2446 Remove the mark from the current group
2447 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2451 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2452 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2456 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2457 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2461 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2462 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2466 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2467 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2468 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2471 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2473 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2474 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2475 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2476 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2477 the command to be executed.
2480 @node Foreign Groups
2481 @section Foreign Groups
2482 @cindex foreign groups
2484 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2485 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2486 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2487 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2494 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2495 @cindex making groups
2496 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2497 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2498 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2502 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2503 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2504 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2508 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2509 @cindex renaming groups
2510 Rename the current group to something else
2511 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2512 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2518 @findex gnus-group-customize
2519 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2523 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2524 @cindex renaming groups
2525 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2526 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2530 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2531 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2532 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2536 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2537 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2538 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2542 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2544 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2545 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2550 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2551 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2555 @cindex (ding) archive
2556 @cindex archive group
2557 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2558 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2559 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2560 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2561 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2562 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2563 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2567 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2569 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2570 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2571 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2572 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2576 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2578 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2579 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2580 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2584 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2585 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2587 Make a group based on some file or other
2588 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2589 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2590 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2591 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2592 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2593 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2594 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2595 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2596 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2600 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2601 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2602 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2603 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2607 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2611 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2612 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2613 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2614 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2615 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2616 @xref{Web Searches}.
2618 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2619 to a particular group by using a match string like
2620 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2624 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2625 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2626 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2630 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2631 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2632 This function will delete the current group
2633 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2634 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2635 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2636 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2637 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2641 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2642 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2643 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2647 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2648 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2649 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2652 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2655 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2656 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2657 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2658 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2659 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2660 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2664 @node Group Parameters
2665 @section Group Parameters
2666 @cindex group parameters
2668 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2669 Here's an example group parameter list:
2672 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2676 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2677 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2678 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2679 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2681 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2682 is an alist of regexps and values.
2684 The following group parameters can be used:
2689 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2692 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2695 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2696 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2697 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2698 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2699 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2701 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2702 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2703 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2704 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2705 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2706 list address instead.
2708 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2712 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2715 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2718 It is totally ignored
2719 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2720 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2722 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2723 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2724 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2725 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2726 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2728 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2729 @cindex mail list groups
2730 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2731 entering summary buffer.
2733 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2738 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2739 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2740 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2741 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2742 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2743 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2744 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2745 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2748 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2749 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2752 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2753 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2757 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2758 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2759 of whether it has any unread articles.
2761 @item broken-reply-to
2762 @cindex broken-reply-to
2763 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2764 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2765 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2766 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2767 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2768 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2772 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2773 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2777 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2778 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2779 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2784 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2785 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2786 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2787 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2788 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2789 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2790 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2792 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2793 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2794 doesn't accept articles.
2798 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2799 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2800 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2802 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2805 @cindex total-expire
2806 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2807 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2808 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2809 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2812 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2816 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2817 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2818 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2819 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2820 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2821 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2822 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2825 @cindex expiry-target
2826 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2827 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2830 @cindex score file group parameter
2831 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2832 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2833 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2836 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2837 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2838 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2839 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2842 @cindex admin-address
2843 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2844 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2845 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2846 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2850 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2851 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2855 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2858 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2859 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2862 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2866 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2868 Here are some examples:
2872 Display only unread articles.
2875 Display everything except expirable articles.
2877 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2878 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2882 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2883 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2884 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2885 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2886 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2890 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2891 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2892 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2896 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2897 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2898 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2902 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2903 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2904 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2906 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2908 @item ignored-charsets
2909 @cindex ignored-charset
2910 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2911 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2912 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2914 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2917 @cindex posting-style
2918 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2919 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2920 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2921 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2922 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2924 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2925 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2926 like this in the group parameters:
2931 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2932 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2937 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2938 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2942 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2943 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2944 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2945 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2946 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2950 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2951 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2952 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2953 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2955 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2956 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2957 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2958 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2961 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2962 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2966 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
2967 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
2969 @item (agent parameters)
2970 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
2971 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
2972 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
2973 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
2974 minimize the configuration effort.
2976 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2977 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2978 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2979 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2980 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2981 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2982 @code{eval}ed there.
2984 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
2985 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
2986 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
2987 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
2988 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
2989 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
2990 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
2991 @file{~/.gnus} file:
2994 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
2997 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
2998 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
2999 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3002 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3005 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3006 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3007 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3008 into the group parameters for the group.
3010 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3011 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3012 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3013 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3016 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3017 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3018 following is added to a group parameter
3021 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3022 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3025 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3030 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3031 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3032 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3033 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3034 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3036 @vindex gnus-parameters
3037 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3038 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect. For
3042 (setq gnus-parameters
3044 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3045 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3046 (gnus-summary-line-format
3047 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3051 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3055 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3059 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3062 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3063 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3065 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3066 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3067 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3068 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3069 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3070 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3071 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3072 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3073 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3074 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3075 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3076 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3079 @node Listing Groups
3080 @section Listing Groups
3081 @cindex group listing
3083 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3091 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3092 List all groups that have unread articles
3093 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3094 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3095 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3096 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3103 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3104 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3105 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3106 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3107 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3108 unsubscribed groups).
3112 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3113 List all unread groups on a specific level
3114 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3115 with no unread articles.
3119 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3120 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3121 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3122 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3127 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3128 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3132 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3133 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3134 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3138 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3139 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3143 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3144 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3145 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3146 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3147 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3148 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3149 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3150 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3154 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3155 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3156 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3160 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3161 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3162 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3166 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3167 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3171 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3172 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3176 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3177 List groups limited within the current selection
3178 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3182 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3183 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3187 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3188 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3192 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3193 @cindex visible group parameter
3194 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3195 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3196 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3197 get the same effect.
3199 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3200 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3201 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3202 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3203 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3206 @node Sorting Groups
3207 @section Sorting Groups
3208 @cindex sorting groups
3210 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3211 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3212 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3213 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3214 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3215 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3220 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3221 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3222 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3224 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3225 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3226 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3228 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3229 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3230 Sort by group level.
3232 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3233 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3234 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3236 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3237 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3238 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3239 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3241 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3242 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3243 Sort by number of unread articles.
3245 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3246 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3247 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3249 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3250 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3251 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3256 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3257 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3261 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3262 some sorting criteria:
3266 @kindex G S a (Group)
3267 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3268 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3269 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3272 @kindex G S u (Group)
3273 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3274 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3275 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3278 @kindex G S l (Group)
3279 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3280 Sort the group buffer by group level
3281 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3284 @kindex G S v (Group)
3285 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3286 Sort the group buffer by group score
3287 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3290 @kindex G S r (Group)
3291 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3292 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3293 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3296 @kindex G S m (Group)
3297 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3298 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3299 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3302 @kindex G S n (Group)
3303 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3304 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3305 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3309 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3310 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3312 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3313 commands will sort in reverse order.
3315 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3319 @kindex G P a (Group)
3320 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3321 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3322 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3325 @kindex G P u (Group)
3326 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3327 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3328 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3331 @kindex G P l (Group)
3332 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3333 Sort the groups by group level
3334 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3337 @kindex G P v (Group)
3338 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3339 Sort the groups by group score
3340 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3343 @kindex G P r (Group)
3344 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3345 Sort the groups by group rank
3346 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3349 @kindex G P m (Group)
3350 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3351 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3352 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3355 @kindex G P n (Group)
3356 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3357 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3358 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3361 @kindex G P s (Group)
3362 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3363 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3367 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3371 @node Group Maintenance
3372 @section Group Maintenance
3373 @cindex bogus groups
3378 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3379 Find bogus groups and delete them
3380 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3384 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3385 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3386 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3387 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3388 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3392 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3393 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3394 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3395 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3396 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3397 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3400 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3401 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3402 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3403 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3408 @node Browse Foreign Server
3409 @section Browse Foreign Server
3410 @cindex foreign servers
3411 @cindex browsing servers
3416 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3417 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3418 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3419 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3422 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3423 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3424 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3425 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3427 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3432 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3433 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3437 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3438 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3441 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3442 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3443 Enter the current group and display the first article
3444 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3447 @kindex RET (Browse)
3448 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3449 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3453 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3454 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3455 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3461 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3462 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3466 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3467 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3471 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3472 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3473 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3478 @section Exiting Gnus
3479 @cindex exiting Gnus
3481 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3486 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3487 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3488 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3489 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3493 @findex gnus-group-exit
3494 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3495 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3499 @findex gnus-group-quit
3500 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3501 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3504 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3505 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3506 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3507 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3508 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3509 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3515 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3516 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3517 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3523 @section Group Topics
3526 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3527 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3528 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3529 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3530 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3531 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3535 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3536 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3547 2: alt.religion.emacs
3550 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3552 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3553 13: comp.sources.unix
3556 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3558 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3559 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3560 is a toggling command.)
3562 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3563 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3564 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3565 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3568 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3569 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3570 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3573 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3577 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3578 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3579 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3580 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3581 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3585 @node Topic Commands
3586 @subsection Topic Commands
3587 @cindex topic commands
3589 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3590 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3591 definitions slightly.
3593 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3594 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3595 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3596 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3597 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3598 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3600 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3607 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3608 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3609 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3613 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3615 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3616 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3617 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3618 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3621 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3622 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3623 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3624 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3628 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3629 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3630 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3631 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3637 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3638 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3639 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3643 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3644 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3645 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3648 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3649 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3650 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3651 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3652 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3654 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3655 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3659 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3660 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3667 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3669 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3670 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3671 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3672 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3673 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3674 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3678 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3684 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3685 Move the current group to some other topic
3686 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3687 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3691 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3692 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3696 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3697 Copy the current group to some other topic
3698 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3699 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3703 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3704 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3705 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3709 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3710 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3711 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3715 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3716 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3717 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3718 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3719 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3720 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3721 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3724 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3725 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3729 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3730 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3731 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3735 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3736 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3737 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3741 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3742 Toggle hiding empty topics
3743 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3747 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3748 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3749 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3750 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3753 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3754 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3755 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3756 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3757 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3760 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3761 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3762 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3763 expiry process (if any)
3764 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3768 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3769 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3772 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3773 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3774 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3778 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3779 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3780 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3783 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3784 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3785 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3788 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3789 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3790 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3794 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3795 @cindex group parameters
3796 @cindex topic parameters
3798 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3799 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3804 @node Topic Variables
3805 @subsection Topic Variables
3806 @cindex topic variables
3808 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3809 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3811 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3812 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3813 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3826 Number of groups in the topic.
3828 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3830 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3833 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3834 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3835 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3838 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3839 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3841 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3842 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3843 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3847 @subsection Topic Sorting
3848 @cindex topic sorting
3850 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3856 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3857 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3858 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3859 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3862 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3863 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3864 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3865 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3868 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3869 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3870 Sort the current topic by group level
3871 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3874 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3875 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3876 Sort the current topic by group score
3877 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3880 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3881 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3882 Sort the current topic by group rank
3883 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3886 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3887 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3888 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3889 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3892 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3893 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3894 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3895 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3898 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3899 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3900 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3901 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3902 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3906 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3907 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3911 @node Topic Topology
3912 @subsection Topic Topology
3913 @cindex topic topology
3916 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3923 2: alt.religion.emacs
3926 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3928 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3929 13: comp.sources.unix
3933 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3934 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3935 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3940 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3941 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3945 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3946 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3947 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3948 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3949 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3950 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3952 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3953 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3954 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3957 @node Topic Parameters
3958 @subsection Topic Parameters
3959 @cindex topic parameters
3961 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
3962 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
3963 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
3964 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
3965 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
3967 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3972 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3973 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3974 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3977 @item subscribe-level
3978 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
3979 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
3980 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
3984 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3985 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3986 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3987 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3994 2: alt.religion.emacs
3998 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4000 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4001 13: comp.sources.unix
4006 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4007 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4008 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4009 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4010 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4011 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4013 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4014 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4015 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4016 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4017 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4019 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4020 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4021 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4022 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4023 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4024 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4025 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4026 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4029 @node Misc Group Stuff
4030 @section Misc Group Stuff
4033 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4034 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4035 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4036 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4037 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4044 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4045 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4046 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4050 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4051 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4052 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4053 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4054 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4055 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4056 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4060 @findex gnus-group-mail
4061 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4062 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4063 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4064 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4068 @findex gnus-group-news
4069 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4070 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4071 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4073 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4074 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4075 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4076 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4077 for this to work though.
4081 Variables for the group buffer:
4085 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4086 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4087 is called after the group buffer has been
4090 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4091 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4092 is called after the group buffer is
4093 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4096 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4097 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4098 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4099 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4101 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4102 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4103 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4104 whether they are empty or not.
4106 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4107 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4108 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4109 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4113 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4114 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4117 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4118 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4119 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4120 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4121 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4122 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4123 default is @code{nil}.
4127 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4128 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4133 @node Scanning New Messages
4134 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4135 @cindex new messages
4136 @cindex scanning new news
4142 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4143 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4144 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4145 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4146 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4147 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4152 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4153 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4154 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4155 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4156 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4157 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4158 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4160 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4161 @cindex activating groups
4163 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4164 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4169 @findex gnus-group-restart
4170 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4171 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4172 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4176 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4177 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4179 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4180 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4184 @node Group Information
4185 @subsection Group Information
4186 @cindex group information
4187 @cindex information on groups
4194 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4195 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4198 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4199 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4200 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4201 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4202 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4203 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4204 used for fetching the file.
4206 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4207 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4211 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4212 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4214 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4215 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4218 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4219 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4220 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4224 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4225 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4226 @cindex control message
4227 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4228 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4229 group if given a prefix argument.
4231 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4232 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4233 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4234 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4236 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4237 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4238 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4242 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4244 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4245 @cindex describing groups
4246 @cindex group description
4247 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4248 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4249 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4253 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4254 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4255 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4262 @findex gnus-version
4263 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4267 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4268 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4271 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4274 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4275 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4279 @node Group Timestamp
4280 @subsection Group Timestamp
4282 @cindex group timestamps
4284 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4285 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4286 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4289 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4292 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4294 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4295 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4298 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4299 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4302 This will result in lines looking like:
4305 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4306 0: custom 19961002T012713
4309 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4310 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4314 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4315 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4318 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4319 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4323 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4324 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4325 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4326 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4328 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4334 @subsection File Commands
4335 @cindex file commands
4341 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4342 @vindex gnus-init-file
4343 @cindex reading init file
4344 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4345 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4349 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4350 @cindex saving .newsrc
4351 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4352 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4353 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4356 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4357 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4358 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4363 @node Sieve Commands
4364 @subsection Sieve Commands
4365 @cindex group sieve commands
4367 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4368 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4369 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4370 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4371 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4373 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4374 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4375 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4376 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4377 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4378 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4379 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4380 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4381 regenerate the Sieve script.
4383 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4384 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4385 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4386 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4387 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4388 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4389 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4390 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4391 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4392 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4395 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4396 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4401 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4407 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4408 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4409 @cindex generating sieve script
4410 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4411 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4415 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4416 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4417 @cindex updating sieve script
4418 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4419 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4420 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4425 @node Summary Buffer
4426 @chapter Summary Buffer
4427 @cindex summary buffer
4429 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4430 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4432 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4433 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4435 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4438 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4439 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4440 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4441 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4442 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4443 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4444 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4445 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4446 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4447 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4448 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4449 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4450 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4451 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4452 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4453 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4454 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4455 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4456 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4457 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4458 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4459 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4460 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4461 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4462 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4463 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4464 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4465 or reselecting the current group.
4466 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4467 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4468 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4469 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4473 @node Summary Buffer Format
4474 @section Summary Buffer Format
4475 @cindex summary buffer format
4479 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4480 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4481 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4487 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4488 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4489 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4490 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4493 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4494 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4495 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4496 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4497 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4498 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4499 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4500 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4501 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4502 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4503 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4506 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4507 'mail-extract-address-components)
4510 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4511 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4512 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4513 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4516 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4517 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4519 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4520 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4521 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4522 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4523 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4525 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4526 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4527 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4528 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4529 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4530 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4532 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4534 The following format specification characters and extended format
4535 specification(s) are understood:
4541 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4542 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4544 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4545 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4546 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4548 Full @code{From} header.
4550 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4552 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4555 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4556 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4557 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4558 may be more thorough.
4560 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4563 Number of lines in the article.
4565 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4566 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4568 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4569 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4571 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4573 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4574 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4587 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4588 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4589 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4590 line-drawing glyphs.
4592 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4593 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4594 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4595 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4597 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4598 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4599 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4600 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4602 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4603 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4604 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4605 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4607 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4608 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4609 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4611 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4612 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4613 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4615 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4616 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4617 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4619 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4620 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4621 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4626 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4627 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4629 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4630 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4632 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4633 for adopted articles.
4635 One space for each thread level.
4637 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4639 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4642 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4643 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4644 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4647 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4649 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4650 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4651 default level. If the difference between
4652 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4653 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4661 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4663 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4669 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4670 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4672 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4673 article has any children.
4679 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4680 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4682 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4683 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4684 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4685 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4686 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4687 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4690 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4691 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4692 There can only be one such area.
4694 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4695 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4696 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4697 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4698 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4699 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4701 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4702 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4704 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4707 @node To From Newsgroups
4708 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4712 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4713 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4714 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4715 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4716 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4720 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4721 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4722 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4726 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4727 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4730 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4731 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4734 @findex gnus-extra-header
4735 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4736 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4737 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4740 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4744 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4745 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4746 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4747 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4748 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4749 headers are used instead.
4753 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4754 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4755 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4756 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4757 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4758 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4761 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4762 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4763 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4764 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4766 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4770 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4772 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4773 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4774 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4775 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4779 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4782 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4783 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4786 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4787 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4788 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4794 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4795 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4798 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4799 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4801 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4802 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4803 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4804 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4806 Here are the elements you can play with:
4812 Unprefixed group name.
4814 Current article number.
4816 Current article score.
4820 Number of unread articles in this group.
4822 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4825 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4826 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4827 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4828 and no unselected ones.
4830 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4831 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4833 Subject of the current article.
4835 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4837 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4839 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4841 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4843 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4845 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4849 @node Summary Highlighting
4850 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4854 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4855 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4856 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4857 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4858 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4860 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4861 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4862 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4863 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4865 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4866 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4867 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4868 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4870 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4871 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4872 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4873 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4874 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4875 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4878 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4879 ((> score default) . bold))
4881 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4882 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4886 @node Summary Maneuvering
4887 @section Summary Maneuvering
4888 @cindex summary movement
4890 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4891 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4893 None of these commands select articles.
4898 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4899 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4900 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4901 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4902 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4906 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4907 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4908 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4909 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4910 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4913 @kindex G g (Summary)
4914 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4915 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4916 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4919 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4920 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4921 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4922 to the group buffer.
4924 Variables related to summary movement:
4928 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4929 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4930 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4931 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4932 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4933 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4934 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4935 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
4936 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
4937 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
4938 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
4939 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
4940 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
4941 @pxref{Group Levels}.
4943 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4944 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4945 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4946 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4947 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4948 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4949 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4951 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4953 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4954 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4955 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4956 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4957 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4959 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4960 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4961 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4962 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4963 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4964 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4965 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4966 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4969 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4970 the given number of lines from the top.
4975 @node Choosing Articles
4976 @section Choosing Articles
4977 @cindex selecting articles
4980 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4981 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4985 @node Choosing Commands
4986 @subsection Choosing Commands
4988 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4989 and they all select and display an article.
4991 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
4992 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4996 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4997 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4998 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
4999 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5001 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5002 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5003 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5008 @kindex G n (Summary)
5009 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5010 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5011 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5016 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5017 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5018 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5023 @kindex G N (Summary)
5024 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5025 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5030 @kindex G P (Summary)
5031 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5032 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5035 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5036 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5037 Go to the next article with the same subject
5038 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5041 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5042 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5043 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5044 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5048 @kindex G f (Summary)
5050 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5051 Go to the first unread article
5052 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5056 @kindex G b (Summary)
5058 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5059 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5060 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5061 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5066 @kindex G l (Summary)
5067 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5068 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5071 @kindex G o (Summary)
5072 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5074 @cindex article history
5075 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5076 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5077 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5078 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5079 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5080 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5085 @kindex G j (Summary)
5086 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5087 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5088 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5093 @node Choosing Variables
5094 @subsection Choosing Variables
5096 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5099 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5100 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5101 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5102 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5103 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5104 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5106 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5107 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5108 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5109 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5110 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5113 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5114 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5115 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5116 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5117 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5118 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5119 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5120 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5121 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5122 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5123 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5124 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5125 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5126 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5131 @node Paging the Article
5132 @section Scrolling the Article
5133 @cindex article scrolling
5138 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5139 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5140 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5141 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5142 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5144 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5145 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5146 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5147 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5148 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5149 what is considered uninteresting with
5150 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5151 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5154 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5155 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5156 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5159 @kindex RET (Summary)
5160 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5161 Scroll the current article one line forward
5162 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5165 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5166 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5167 Scroll the current article one line backward
5168 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5172 @kindex A g (Summary)
5174 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5175 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5176 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5177 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5178 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5179 the way it came from the server.
5181 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5182 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5183 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5186 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5191 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5196 @kindex A < (Summary)
5197 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5198 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5199 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5204 @kindex A > (Summary)
5205 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5206 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5210 @kindex A s (Summary)
5212 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5213 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5214 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5218 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5219 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5224 @node Reply Followup and Post
5225 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5228 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5229 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5230 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5231 * Canceling and Superseding::
5235 @node Summary Mail Commands
5236 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5238 @cindex composing mail
5240 Commands for composing a mail message:
5246 @kindex S r (Summary)
5248 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5249 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5250 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5251 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5252 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5257 @kindex S R (Summary)
5258 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5259 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5260 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5261 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5262 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5265 @kindex S w (Summary)
5266 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5267 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5268 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5269 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5270 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5271 present, that's used instead.
5274 @kindex S W (Summary)
5275 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5276 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5277 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5278 the process/prefix convention.
5281 @kindex S v (Summary)
5282 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5283 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5284 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5285 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5286 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5287 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5290 @kindex S V (Summary)
5291 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5292 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5293 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5294 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5297 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5298 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5299 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5300 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5301 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5302 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5303 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5304 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5307 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5308 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5309 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5310 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5311 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5315 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5316 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5317 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5318 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5319 Forward the current article to some other person
5320 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5321 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5322 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5323 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5324 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5325 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5326 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5327 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5328 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5334 @kindex S m (Summary)
5335 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5336 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5337 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5338 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5339 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5344 @kindex S i (Summary)
5345 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5346 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5347 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5348 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5350 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5351 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5352 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5353 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5354 for this to work though.
5357 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5358 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5359 @cindex bouncing mail
5360 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5361 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5362 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5363 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5364 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5365 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5366 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5367 very well fail, though.
5370 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5371 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5372 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5373 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5374 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5375 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5376 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5377 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5378 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5379 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5381 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5382 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5383 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5384 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5385 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5387 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5388 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5391 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5392 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5394 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5395 if it were a new message before resending.
5398 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5399 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5400 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5401 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5402 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5405 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5406 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5407 @cindex crossposting
5408 @cindex excessive crossposting
5409 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5410 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5412 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5413 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5414 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5415 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5416 command understands the process/prefix convention
5417 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5421 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5422 Manual}, for more information.
5425 @node Summary Post Commands
5426 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5428 @cindex composing news
5430 Commands for posting a news article:
5436 @kindex S p (Summary)
5437 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5438 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5439 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5440 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5441 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5446 @kindex S f (Summary)
5447 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5448 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5449 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5453 @kindex S F (Summary)
5455 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5456 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5457 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5458 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5459 process/prefix convention.
5462 @kindex S n (Summary)
5463 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5464 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5465 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5468 @kindex S N (Summary)
5469 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5470 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5471 message through mail and include the original message
5472 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5473 the process/prefix convention.
5476 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5477 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5478 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5479 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5480 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5481 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5482 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5483 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5484 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5485 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5486 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5487 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5488 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5491 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5492 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5494 @cindex making digests
5495 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5496 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5497 process/prefix convention.
5500 @kindex S u (Summary)
5501 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5502 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5503 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5504 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5507 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5508 Manual}, for more information.
5511 @node Summary Message Commands
5512 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5516 @kindex S y (Summary)
5517 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5518 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5519 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5520 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5521 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5526 @node Canceling and Superseding
5527 @subsection Canceling Articles
5528 @cindex canceling articles
5529 @cindex superseding articles
5531 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5532 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5534 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5536 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5538 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5539 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5540 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5541 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5542 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5543 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5545 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5546 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5549 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5550 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5551 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5553 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5554 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5555 message, Message Manual}).
5557 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5558 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5559 your original article.
5561 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5563 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5564 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5565 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5568 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5569 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5570 have posted almost the same article twice.
5572 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5573 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5574 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5575 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5576 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5577 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5578 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5579 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5580 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5581 canceled/superseded.
5583 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5585 @node Delayed Articles
5586 @section Delayed Articles
5587 @cindex delayed sending
5588 @cindex send delayed
5590 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5591 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5592 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5593 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5596 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5599 @findex gnus-delay-article
5600 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5601 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5602 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5603 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5607 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5608 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5609 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5610 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5613 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5614 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5615 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5618 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5619 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5620 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5621 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5622 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5623 that means a time tomorrow.
5626 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5627 couple of variables:
5630 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5631 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5632 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5633 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5635 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5636 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5637 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5638 formats described above.
5640 @item gnus-delay-group
5641 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5642 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5643 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5644 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5646 @item gnus-delay-header
5647 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5648 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5649 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5650 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5653 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5654 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5655 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5656 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5657 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5659 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5660 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5661 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5662 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5663 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5664 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5665 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5668 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5669 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5670 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5671 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5672 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5673 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5674 argument is ignored.
5676 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5677 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5678 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5682 @node Marking Articles
5683 @section Marking Articles
5684 @cindex article marking
5685 @cindex article ticking
5688 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5690 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5691 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5692 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5694 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5697 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5701 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5702 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5703 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5704 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5705 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5706 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5710 @node Unread Articles
5711 @subsection Unread Articles
5713 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5718 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5719 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5721 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5722 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5723 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5724 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5725 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5726 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5727 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5730 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5731 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5733 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5734 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5735 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5736 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5740 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5741 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5743 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5748 @subsection Read Articles
5749 @cindex expirable mark
5751 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5756 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5757 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5758 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5761 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5762 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5765 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5766 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5767 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5770 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5771 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5774 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5775 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5778 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5779 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5782 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5783 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5786 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5787 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5790 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5791 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5794 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5795 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5799 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5800 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5801 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5805 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5806 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5808 One more special mark, though:
5812 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5813 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5815 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5816 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5817 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5818 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5824 @subsection Other Marks
5825 @cindex process mark
5828 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5834 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5835 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5836 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5837 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5838 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5841 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5842 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5843 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5844 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5847 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5848 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5849 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5852 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5853 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5854 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5857 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5858 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5859 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5860 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5863 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5864 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5865 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5866 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5867 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5868 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5871 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5872 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5873 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5874 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5877 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5878 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5879 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5880 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5881 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5885 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5886 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5887 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5888 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5889 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5890 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5893 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5894 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5895 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5896 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5897 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5898 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5902 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5903 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5904 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5905 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5906 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5909 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5910 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5911 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5912 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5913 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5914 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5918 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5919 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5920 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5922 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5923 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5924 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5928 @subsection Setting Marks
5929 @cindex setting marks
5931 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5936 @kindex M c (Summary)
5937 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5938 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5939 @cindex mark as unread
5940 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5941 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5947 @kindex M t (Summary)
5948 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5949 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5950 @xref{Article Caching}.
5955 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5956 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5957 Mark the current article as dormant
5958 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5962 @kindex M d (Summary)
5964 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5965 Mark the current article as read
5966 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5970 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5971 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5972 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5977 @kindex M k (Summary)
5978 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5979 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5980 and then select the next unread article
5981 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5985 @kindex M K (Summary)
5986 @kindex C-k (Summary)
5987 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5988 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5989 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5992 @kindex M C (Summary)
5993 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
5994 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
5995 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
5998 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
5999 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6000 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6001 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6004 @kindex M H (Summary)
6005 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6006 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6007 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6010 @kindex M h (Summary)
6011 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6012 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6013 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6016 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6017 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6018 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6019 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6022 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6023 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6024 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6025 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6029 @kindex M e (Summary)
6031 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6032 Mark the current article as expirable
6033 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6036 @kindex M b (Summary)
6037 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6038 Set a bookmark in the current article
6039 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6042 @kindex M B (Summary)
6043 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6044 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6045 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6048 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6049 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6050 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6051 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6054 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6055 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6056 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6057 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6060 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6061 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6062 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6063 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6064 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6067 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6068 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6069 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6070 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6071 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6072 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6073 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6074 The default is @code{t}.
6077 @node Generic Marking Commands
6078 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6080 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6081 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6082 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6083 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6084 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6087 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6088 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6091 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6092 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6093 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6094 to list in this manual.
6096 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6097 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6098 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6099 article, you could say something like:
6103 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6104 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6105 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6113 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6114 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6118 @node Setting Process Marks
6119 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6120 @cindex setting process marks
6122 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6123 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6124 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6125 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6126 commands into the cache. For more information,
6127 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6134 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6135 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6136 Mark the current article with the process mark
6137 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6138 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6142 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6143 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6144 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6145 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6148 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6149 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6150 Remove the process mark from all articles
6151 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6154 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6155 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6156 Invert the list of process marked articles
6157 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6160 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6161 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6162 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6163 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6166 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6167 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6168 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6169 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6172 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6173 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6174 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6177 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6178 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6179 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6182 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6183 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6184 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6185 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6188 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6189 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6190 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6191 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6194 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6195 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6196 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6197 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6200 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6201 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6202 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6205 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6206 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6207 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6208 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6211 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6212 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6213 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6216 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6217 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6218 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6219 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6222 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6223 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6224 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6225 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6228 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6229 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6230 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6231 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6234 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6235 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6236 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6237 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6241 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6242 set process marks based on article body contents.
6249 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6250 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6251 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6254 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6255 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6256 additional articles.
6262 @kindex / / (Summary)
6263 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6264 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6265 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6269 @kindex / a (Summary)
6270 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6271 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6272 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6276 @kindex / x (Summary)
6277 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6278 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6279 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6280 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6285 @kindex / u (Summary)
6287 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6288 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6289 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6290 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6291 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6294 @kindex / m (Summary)
6295 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6296 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6297 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6300 @kindex / t (Summary)
6301 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6302 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6303 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6304 articles younger than that number of days.
6307 @kindex / n (Summary)
6308 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6309 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
6310 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
6311 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6314 @kindex / w (Summary)
6315 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6316 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6317 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6321 @kindex / . (Summary)
6322 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6323 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6324 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6327 @kindex / v (Summary)
6328 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6329 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6330 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6333 @kindex / p (Summary)
6334 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6335 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6336 group parameter predicate
6337 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6338 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6342 @kindex M S (Summary)
6343 @kindex / E (Summary)
6344 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6345 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6346 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6349 @kindex / D (Summary)
6350 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6351 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6352 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6355 @kindex / * (Summary)
6356 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6357 Include all cached articles in the limit
6358 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6361 @kindex / d (Summary)
6362 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6363 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6364 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6367 @kindex / M (Summary)
6368 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6369 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6372 @kindex / T (Summary)
6373 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6374 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6377 @kindex / c (Summary)
6378 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6379 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6380 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6383 @kindex / C (Summary)
6384 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6385 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6386 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6387 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6390 @kindex / N (Summary)
6391 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6392 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6393 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6396 @kindex / o (Summary)
6397 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6398 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6399 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6407 @cindex article threading
6409 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6410 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6411 hierarchical fashion.
6413 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6414 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6415 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6416 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6417 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6418 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6419 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6421 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6425 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6428 A tree-like article structure.
6431 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6434 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6435 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6436 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6437 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6438 called loose threads.
6440 @item thread gathering
6441 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6443 @item sparse threads
6444 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6445 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6451 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6452 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6456 @node Customizing Threading
6457 @subsection Customizing Threading
6458 @cindex customizing threading
6461 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6462 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6463 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6464 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6469 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6472 @cindex loose threads
6475 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6476 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6477 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6478 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6479 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6480 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6482 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6483 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6484 There are four possible values:
6488 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6489 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6490 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6491 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6492 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6497 @cindex adopting articles
6502 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6503 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6504 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6505 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6508 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6509 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6510 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6511 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6512 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6513 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6514 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6515 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6516 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6517 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6520 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6521 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6522 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6526 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6527 display them after one another.
6530 Don't gather loose threads.
6533 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6534 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6535 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6536 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6537 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6538 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6539 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6540 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6541 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6542 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6543 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6545 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6546 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6547 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6550 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6551 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6552 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6553 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6554 simplification is used.
6556 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6557 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6558 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6559 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6561 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6563 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6569 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6570 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6571 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6572 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6577 (mapconcat 'identity
6578 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6580 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6583 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6586 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6587 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6588 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6589 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6590 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6591 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6593 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6596 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6597 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6598 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6600 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6601 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6604 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6605 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6606 Remove excessive whitespace.
6608 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6609 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6610 Remove all whitespace.
6613 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6616 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6617 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6618 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6619 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6620 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6621 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6622 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6623 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6625 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6626 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6627 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6628 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6629 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6630 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6631 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6632 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6633 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6637 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6638 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6639 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6640 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6642 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6643 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6644 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6647 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6651 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6652 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6658 @node Filling In Threads
6659 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6662 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6663 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6664 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6665 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6666 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6667 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6668 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6669 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6670 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6671 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6672 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6673 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6676 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6677 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6678 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6680 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6681 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6682 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6685 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6686 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6687 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6688 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6689 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6690 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6691 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6692 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6693 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6694 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6695 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6696 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6697 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6698 @code{nil} by default.
6700 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6701 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6702 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6703 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6704 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6705 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6706 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6708 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6709 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6710 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6715 @node More Threading
6716 @subsubsection More Threading
6719 @item gnus-show-threads
6720 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6721 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6722 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6723 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6724 slower and more awkward.
6726 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6727 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6728 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6731 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6732 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6733 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6738 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6739 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6740 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6743 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6744 unread, but you get my drift.)
6747 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6748 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6749 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6750 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6751 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6752 threads are expunged.
6754 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6755 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6756 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6759 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6760 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6761 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6762 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6763 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6764 result in a new thread.
6766 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6767 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6768 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6771 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6772 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6773 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6774 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6775 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6776 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6777 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6778 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6779 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6780 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6781 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6786 @node Low-Level Threading
6787 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6791 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6792 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6793 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6795 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6796 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6797 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6798 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6799 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6800 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6801 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6802 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6803 meaningful. Here's one example:
6806 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6808 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6809 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6811 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6813 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6820 @node Thread Commands
6821 @subsection Thread Commands
6822 @cindex thread commands
6828 @kindex T k (Summary)
6829 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6830 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6831 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6832 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6833 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6838 @kindex T l (Summary)
6839 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6840 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6841 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6842 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6845 @kindex T i (Summary)
6846 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6847 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6848 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6851 @kindex T # (Summary)
6852 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6853 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6854 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6857 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6858 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6859 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6860 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6863 @kindex T T (Summary)
6864 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6865 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6868 @kindex T s (Summary)
6869 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6870 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6871 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6874 @kindex T h (Summary)
6875 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6876 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6879 @kindex T S (Summary)
6880 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6881 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6884 @kindex T H (Summary)
6885 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6886 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6889 @kindex T t (Summary)
6890 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6891 Re-thread the current article's thread
6892 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6893 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6896 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6897 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6898 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6899 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6903 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6904 understand the numeric prefix.
6909 @kindex T n (Summary)
6911 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6913 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6914 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6915 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6918 @kindex T p (Summary)
6920 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6922 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6923 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6924 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6927 @kindex T d (Summary)
6928 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6929 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6932 @kindex T u (Summary)
6933 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6934 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6937 @kindex T o (Summary)
6938 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6939 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6942 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6943 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6944 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6945 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6946 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6947 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6948 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
6949 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
6950 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
6951 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
6952 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
6953 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
6957 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
6958 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
6960 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
6961 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
6962 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
6963 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6964 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
6965 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6966 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
6967 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
6968 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
6969 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
6970 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
6971 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
6972 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
6973 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
6975 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
6976 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
6977 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
6978 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
6979 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
6980 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
6981 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
6982 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
6984 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
6985 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
6986 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
6988 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
6989 last function in the list. You should probably always include
6990 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
6991 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
6992 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
6993 ascending article order.
6995 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
6996 by number, you could do something like:
6999 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7000 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7001 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7002 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7005 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7006 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7007 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7008 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7009 which the articles arrived.
7011 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7015 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7017 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7018 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7021 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7022 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7023 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7024 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7027 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7028 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7029 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7030 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7031 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7032 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7033 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7034 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7035 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7036 variable. It is very similar to the
7037 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7038 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7039 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7040 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7041 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7042 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7043 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7045 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7049 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7050 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7051 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7056 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7057 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7058 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7059 @cindex article pre-fetch
7062 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7063 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7064 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7065 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7066 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7068 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7069 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7071 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7072 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7073 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7074 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7075 connection is blocked.
7077 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7078 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7079 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7080 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7082 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7083 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7084 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7085 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7088 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7091 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7092 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7093 happen automatically.
7095 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7096 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7097 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7098 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7099 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7100 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7101 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7103 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7104 @findex gnus-async-read-p
7105 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7106 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7107 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7108 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7109 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which
7110 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7111 article data structure as the only parameter.
7113 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7114 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7117 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7118 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7119 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7120 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7123 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7126 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7127 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7128 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7130 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7131 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7132 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7133 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7137 Remove articles when they are read.
7140 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7143 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7145 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7146 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7147 @c from the next group.
7150 @node Article Caching
7151 @section Article Caching
7152 @cindex article caching
7155 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7156 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7157 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7158 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7159 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7161 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7163 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7164 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7165 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7166 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7167 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7168 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7169 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7170 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7172 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7173 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7174 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7175 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7176 as dormant, and don't worry.
7178 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7180 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7181 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7182 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7183 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7184 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7185 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7186 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7187 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7188 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7189 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7191 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7192 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7193 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7194 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7195 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7196 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7197 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7198 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7199 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7200 not then be downloaded by this command.
7202 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7203 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7204 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7205 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7206 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7207 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7209 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7210 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7211 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7212 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7213 variables, the group is not cached.
7215 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7216 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7217 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7218 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7219 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7220 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7221 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7222 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7223 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7226 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7227 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7228 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7229 where, isn't that cool?
7231 @node Persistent Articles
7232 @section Persistent Articles
7233 @cindex persistent articles
7235 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7236 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7237 useful in my opinion.
7239 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7240 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7241 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7242 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7243 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7244 the expiry going on at the news server.
7246 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7247 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7248 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7254 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7255 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7258 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7259 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7260 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7261 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7265 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7267 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7268 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7269 interested in persistent articles:
7272 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7276 @node Article Backlog
7277 @section Article Backlog
7279 @cindex article backlog
7281 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7282 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7283 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7284 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7285 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7286 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7287 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7288 increase memory usage some.
7290 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7291 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7292 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7293 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7294 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7295 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7296 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7298 The default value is 20.
7301 @node Saving Articles
7302 @section Saving Articles
7303 @cindex saving articles
7305 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7306 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7307 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7308 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7309 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7311 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7312 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7313 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7315 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7316 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7317 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7319 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7320 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7321 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7322 deleted before saving.
7328 @kindex O o (Summary)
7330 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7331 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7332 Save the current article using the default article saver
7333 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7336 @kindex O m (Summary)
7337 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7338 Save the current article in mail format
7339 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7342 @kindex O r (Summary)
7343 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7344 Save the current article in Rmail format
7345 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7348 @kindex O f (Summary)
7349 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7350 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7351 Save the current article in plain file format
7352 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7355 @kindex O F (Summary)
7356 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7357 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7358 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7361 @kindex O b (Summary)
7362 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7363 Save the current article body in plain file format
7364 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7367 @kindex O h (Summary)
7368 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7369 Save the current article in mh folder format
7370 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7373 @kindex O v (Summary)
7374 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7375 Save the current article in a VM folder
7376 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7380 @kindex O p (Summary)
7382 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7383 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7384 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7385 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7386 complete headers in the piped output.
7389 @kindex O P (Summary)
7390 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7391 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7392 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7393 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7394 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7395 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7396 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7400 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7401 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7402 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7403 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7404 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7405 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7406 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7407 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7408 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7409 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7410 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7411 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7415 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7416 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7417 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
7418 functions below, or you can create your own.
7422 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7423 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7424 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7425 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7426 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7427 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7428 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7430 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7431 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7432 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7433 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7434 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7435 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7437 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7438 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7439 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7440 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7441 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7442 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7443 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7445 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7446 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7447 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7448 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7449 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7450 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7452 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7453 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7454 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7455 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7456 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7458 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7459 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7460 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7461 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7462 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7465 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7466 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7467 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7468 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7469 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7471 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7472 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7473 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7474 reader to use this setting.
7477 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7478 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7479 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7480 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7483 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7484 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7485 available functions that generate names:
7489 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7490 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7491 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7493 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7494 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7495 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7497 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7498 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7499 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7501 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7502 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7503 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7505 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7506 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7507 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7510 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7511 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7512 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7513 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7514 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7518 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7519 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7520 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7521 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7524 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7525 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7526 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7527 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7528 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7529 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7530 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7531 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7532 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7534 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7535 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7536 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7537 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7539 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7540 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7541 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7544 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7545 lots of mail groups called things like
7546 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7547 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7548 following will do just that:
7551 (defun my-save-name (group)
7552 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7553 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7555 (setq gnus-split-methods
7556 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7561 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7562 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7563 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7564 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7565 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7566 all the files in the top level directory
7567 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7568 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7569 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7570 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7572 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7573 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7574 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7575 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7576 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7579 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7583 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7584 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7585 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7588 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7589 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7590 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7591 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7594 @node Decoding Articles
7595 @section Decoding Articles
7596 @cindex decoding articles
7598 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7599 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7602 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7603 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7604 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7605 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7606 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7607 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7611 @cindex article series
7612 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7613 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7614 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7615 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7616 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7618 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7619 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7620 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7622 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7623 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7624 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7626 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7627 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7628 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7631 @node Uuencoded Articles
7632 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7634 @cindex uuencoded articles
7639 @kindex X u (Summary)
7640 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7641 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7642 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7645 @kindex X U (Summary)
7646 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7647 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7648 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7651 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7652 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7653 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7656 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7657 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7658 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7659 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7663 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7664 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7665 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7666 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7667 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7669 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7670 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7671 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7672 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7675 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7676 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7677 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7678 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7679 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7680 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7684 @node Shell Archives
7685 @subsection Shell Archives
7687 @cindex shell archives
7688 @cindex shared articles
7690 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7691 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7692 some commands to deal with these:
7697 @kindex X s (Summary)
7698 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7699 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7702 @kindex X S (Summary)
7703 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7704 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7707 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7708 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7709 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7712 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7713 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7714 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7715 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7719 @node PostScript Files
7720 @subsection PostScript Files
7726 @kindex X p (Summary)
7727 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7728 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7731 @kindex X P (Summary)
7732 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7733 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7734 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7737 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7738 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7739 View the current PostScript series
7740 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7743 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7744 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7745 View and save the current PostScript series
7746 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7751 @subsection Other Files
7755 @kindex X o (Summary)
7756 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7757 Save the current series
7758 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7761 @kindex X b (Summary)
7762 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7763 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7764 doesn't really work yet.
7768 @node Decoding Variables
7769 @subsection Decoding Variables
7771 Adjective, not verb.
7774 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7775 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7776 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7780 @node Rule Variables
7781 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7782 @cindex rule variables
7784 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7785 variables are of the form
7788 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7795 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7796 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7798 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7799 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7802 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7803 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7806 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7807 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7808 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7809 user and default view rules.
7811 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7812 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7813 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7818 @node Other Decode Variables
7819 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7822 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7824 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7825 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7826 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7827 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7828 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7832 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7833 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7836 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7837 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7838 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7841 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7842 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7843 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7844 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7845 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7848 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7849 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7850 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7852 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7853 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7854 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7855 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7856 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7859 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7860 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7861 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7863 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7864 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7865 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7866 looking for files to display.
7868 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7869 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7870 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7873 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7874 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7875 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7878 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7879 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7880 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7883 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7884 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7885 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7888 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7889 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7890 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7891 decoded articles as unread.
7893 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7894 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7895 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7896 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7898 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7899 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7900 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7902 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7903 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7905 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7906 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
7907 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7908 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7910 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7911 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7912 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7913 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7914 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7915 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7916 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
7917 simply dropped them.
7922 @node Uuencoding and Posting
7923 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
7927 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7928 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7929 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
7930 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
7931 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
7932 for you when you post the article.
7934 @item gnus-uu-post-length
7935 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
7936 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
7937 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
7939 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
7940 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
7941 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
7942 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
7943 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
7944 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
7945 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
7947 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7948 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7949 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
7950 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
7951 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
7952 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
7953 Default is @code{t}.
7959 @subsection Viewing Files
7960 @cindex viewing files
7961 @cindex pseudo-articles
7963 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
7964 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
7965 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
7966 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
7967 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
7968 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
7969 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
7971 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
7972 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
7973 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
7974 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
7976 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
7977 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
7978 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
7980 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
7981 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
7982 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
7983 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
7984 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
7986 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
7987 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
7988 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
7989 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
7990 a list of parameters to that command.
7992 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
7993 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
7994 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
7996 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
7997 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
7998 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8001 @node Article Treatment
8002 @section Article Treatment
8004 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8005 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8006 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8007 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8008 these articles easier.
8011 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8012 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8013 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8014 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8015 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8016 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8017 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8018 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8019 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8020 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8021 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8025 @node Article Highlighting
8026 @subsection Article Highlighting
8027 @cindex highlighting
8029 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8030 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8035 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8036 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8037 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8038 Do much highlighting of the current article
8039 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8040 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8043 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8044 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8045 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8046 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8047 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8048 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8049 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8050 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8051 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8052 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8053 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8054 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8057 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8058 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8059 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8061 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8064 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8066 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8067 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
8068 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8070 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8071 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8072 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8074 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8075 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8076 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8077 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8078 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8079 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8081 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8082 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8083 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8085 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8086 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8087 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8089 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8090 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8091 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8092 that it's a citation.
8094 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8095 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8096 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8098 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8099 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8100 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8102 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8103 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8104 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8105 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8107 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8108 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8109 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8110 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8111 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8118 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8119 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8120 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8121 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8122 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8123 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8124 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8125 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8130 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8133 @node Article Fontisizing
8134 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8136 @cindex article emphasis
8138 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8139 @kindex W e (Summary)
8140 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8141 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8142 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8143 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8145 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8146 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8147 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8148 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8149 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8150 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8151 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8152 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8156 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8157 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8158 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8167 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8168 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8169 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8170 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8171 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8172 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8173 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8174 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8175 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8176 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8177 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8178 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8179 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8181 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8182 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8183 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8187 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8190 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8192 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8193 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8194 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8195 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8197 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8200 @node Article Hiding
8201 @subsection Article Hiding
8202 @cindex article hiding
8204 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8205 too much cruft in most articles.
8210 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8211 @findex gnus-article-hide
8212 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8213 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8214 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8217 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8218 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8219 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8223 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8224 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8225 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8226 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8229 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8230 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8231 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8235 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8236 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8237 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8238 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8239 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8240 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8241 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8242 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8246 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8247 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8248 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8249 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8254 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8255 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8256 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8257 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8260 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8261 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8262 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8263 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8266 @cindex stripping advertisements
8267 @cindex advertisements
8268 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8269 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8270 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8271 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8272 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8273 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8274 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8275 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8276 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8277 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8280 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8281 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8282 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8286 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8287 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8288 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8289 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8290 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8291 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8292 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8293 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8294 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8295 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8296 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8299 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8300 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8306 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8307 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8308 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8309 customizing the hiding:
8313 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8314 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8315 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8316 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8317 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8318 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8319 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8324 Starting point of the hidden text.
8326 Ending point of the hidden text.
8328 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8330 Number of lines of hidden text.
8333 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8334 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8335 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8336 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8337 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8342 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8343 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8345 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8346 following two variables:
8349 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8350 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8351 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8352 50), hide the cited text.
8354 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8355 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8356 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8361 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8362 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8363 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8364 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8365 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8366 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8370 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8371 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8372 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8374 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8375 citation customization.
8377 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8381 @node Article Washing
8382 @subsection Article Washing
8384 @cindex article washing
8386 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8387 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8389 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8390 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8393 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8394 articles by default.
8399 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8400 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8404 Force redisplaying of the current article
8405 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8406 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8407 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8408 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8411 @kindex W l (Summary)
8412 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8413 Remove page breaks from the current article
8414 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8418 @kindex W r (Summary)
8419 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8420 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8421 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8422 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8423 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8424 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8426 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8427 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8428 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8429 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8432 @kindex W m (Summary)
8433 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8434 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8438 @kindex W t (Summary)
8440 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8441 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8442 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8445 @kindex W v (Summary)
8446 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8447 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8448 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8451 @kindex W o (Summary)
8452 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8453 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8456 @kindex W d (Summary)
8457 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8458 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8460 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8462 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8463 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8464 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8465 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8468 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8469 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8470 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8471 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8474 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8475 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8476 @cindex Outlook Express
8477 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8478 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8479 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8482 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8483 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8484 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8485 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8486 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8487 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8488 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8489 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8490 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8491 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8494 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8495 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8496 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8497 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8500 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8501 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8502 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8503 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8506 @kindex W w (Summary)
8507 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8508 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8510 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8514 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8515 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8516 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8519 @kindex W C (Summary)
8520 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8521 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8522 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8525 @kindex W c (Summary)
8526 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8527 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8528 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8529 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8530 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8533 @kindex W q (Summary)
8534 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8535 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8536 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8537 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8538 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8539 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8540 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8541 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8542 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8545 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8546 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8547 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8548 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8549 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8550 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8551 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8552 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8555 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8556 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8557 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8558 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8559 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8562 @kindex W u (Summary)
8563 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8564 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8565 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8566 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8567 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8570 @kindex W h (Summary)
8571 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8572 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8573 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8574 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8576 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
8577 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
8578 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
8580 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8581 The default is to use the function specified by
8582 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8583 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8584 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8585 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8593 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8595 @item w3m-standalone
8596 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
8599 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8602 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8605 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8610 @kindex W b (Summary)
8611 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8612 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8613 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8616 @kindex W B (Summary)
8617 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8618 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8619 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8622 @kindex W p (Summary)
8623 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8624 Verify a signed control message
8625 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8626 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8627 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8628 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8629 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8630 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8633 @kindex W s (Summary)
8634 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8635 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8636 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8637 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8640 @kindex W a (Summary)
8641 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8642 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8643 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8646 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8647 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8648 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8649 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8652 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8653 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8654 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8655 lines with a single empty line.
8656 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8659 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8660 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8661 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8662 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8665 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8666 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8667 Do all the three commands above
8668 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8671 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8672 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8673 Remove all blank lines
8674 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8677 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8678 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8679 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8680 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8683 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8684 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8685 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8686 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8690 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8693 @node Article Header
8694 @subsection Article Header
8696 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8701 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8702 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8703 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8706 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8707 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8708 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8709 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8712 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8713 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8714 Fold all the message headers
8715 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8718 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8719 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8720 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8721 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8726 @node Article Buttons
8727 @subsection Article Buttons
8730 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8731 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8732 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8733 button on these references.
8735 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8736 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8737 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8738 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8739 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8743 @item gnus-button-alist
8744 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8745 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8748 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8754 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8755 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8756 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8757 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8758 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8761 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8762 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8763 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8766 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8767 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8768 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8769 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8770 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8772 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8775 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8778 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8779 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8783 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8786 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8789 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8790 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8791 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8792 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8793 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8796 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8799 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8802 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8805 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8806 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8808 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8810 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8811 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8812 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8813 default values of the variables above.
8815 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8817 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8818 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8819 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8820 argument with a string naming the man page.
8822 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8824 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8825 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8826 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8828 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8829 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8830 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8831 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8832 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8833 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8834 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8835 @code{ask}, always query the user what do do. If it is a function, this
8836 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8837 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8838 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8839 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8841 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8842 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8843 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8844 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8845 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8848 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8849 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8850 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8851 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8853 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8855 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8856 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8857 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8858 argument, the string naming the URL.
8861 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8862 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8863 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8867 @item gnus-article-button-face
8868 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8869 Face used on buttons.
8871 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8872 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8873 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8877 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8880 @node Article Button Levels
8881 @subsection Article button levels
8882 @cindex button levels
8883 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8884 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8885 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8886 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8887 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8888 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8889 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8890 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8893 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8894 (setq gnus-parameters
8895 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
8896 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
8897 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
8902 @item gnus-button-browse-level
8903 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
8904 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
8905 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
8906 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
8907 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
8909 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
8910 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
8911 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
8912 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
8913 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
8914 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
8915 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
8916 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
8917 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
8918 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
8919 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
8920 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
8921 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
8923 @item gnus-button-man-level
8924 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
8925 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
8926 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
8928 @item gnus-button-message-level
8929 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
8930 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
8931 Related variables and functions include
8932 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
8933 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
8934 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
8935 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
8937 @item gnus-button-tex-level
8938 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
8939 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
8940 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
8941 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
8942 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
8943 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
8949 @subsection Article Date
8951 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
8952 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
8953 when the article was sent.
8958 @kindex W T u (Summary)
8959 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
8960 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
8961 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
8964 @kindex W T i (Summary)
8965 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
8967 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
8968 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
8971 @kindex W T l (Summary)
8972 @findex gnus-article-date-local
8973 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
8976 @kindex W T p (Summary)
8977 @findex gnus-article-date-english
8978 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
8979 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
8982 @kindex W T s (Summary)
8983 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
8984 @findex gnus-article-date-user
8985 @findex format-time-string
8986 Display the date using a user-defined format
8987 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
8988 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
8989 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
8990 for a list of possible format specs.
8993 @kindex W T e (Summary)
8994 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
8995 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
8996 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
8997 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
8998 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9001 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9004 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
9005 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
9006 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
9009 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
9010 into wonderful absurdities.
9012 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
9015 (gnus-start-date-timer)
9018 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9019 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9023 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9024 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9025 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9026 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9027 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9028 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9029 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9033 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9034 preferred format automatically.
9037 @node Article Display
9038 @subsection Article Display
9043 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9044 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9046 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9047 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9049 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9050 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9052 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9053 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9055 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9056 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9058 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9063 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9064 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9065 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9066 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9069 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9070 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9071 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9072 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9075 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9076 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9077 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9080 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9081 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9082 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9085 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9086 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9087 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9088 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9091 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9092 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9093 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9094 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9097 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9098 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9099 Remove all images from the article buffer
9100 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9106 @node Article Signature
9107 @subsection Article Signature
9109 @cindex article signature
9111 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9112 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9113 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9114 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9115 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9116 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9117 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9118 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9119 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9122 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9123 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9124 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9125 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9126 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9127 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9128 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9129 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9132 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9135 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9136 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9137 signature when displaying articles.
9141 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9144 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9147 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9148 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9150 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9151 in question is not a signature.
9154 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9155 listed above. Here's an example:
9158 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9159 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9162 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9163 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9164 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9165 signature after all.
9168 @node Article Miscellanea
9169 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9173 @kindex A t (Summary)
9174 @findex gnus-article-babel
9175 Translate the article from one language to another
9176 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9182 @section MIME Commands
9183 @cindex MIME decoding
9185 @cindex viewing attachments
9187 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9188 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9194 @kindex K v (Summary)
9195 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9198 @kindex K o (Summary)
9199 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9202 @kindex K c (Summary)
9203 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9206 @kindex K e (Summary)
9207 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9210 @kindex K i (Summary)
9211 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9214 @kindex K | (Summary)
9215 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9218 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9223 @kindex K b (Summary)
9224 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9225 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9229 @kindex K m (Summary)
9230 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9231 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9232 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9233 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9234 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9237 @kindex X m (Summary)
9238 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9239 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9240 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9241 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9244 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9245 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9246 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9247 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9250 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9251 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9252 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9253 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9256 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9257 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9258 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9259 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9261 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9262 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9263 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9264 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9265 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9266 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9269 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9270 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9271 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9272 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9279 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9280 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9281 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9282 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9285 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9288 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9292 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9293 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9294 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9295 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9296 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9297 default is @code{nil}.
9299 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9300 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9301 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9302 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9303 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9304 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9305 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}.
9307 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9308 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9309 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9310 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9311 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9312 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9313 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9314 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9316 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9317 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9318 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9319 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9320 displayed. This variable overrides
9321 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9322 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9325 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9326 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9327 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9329 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9330 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9331 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9332 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9333 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9335 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9336 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9337 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9338 default value is @code{nil}.
9340 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9341 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9342 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9343 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9344 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9345 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9346 save all jpegs into some directory).
9348 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9351 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9352 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9354 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9355 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9356 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9357 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9358 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9361 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9362 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9363 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9365 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9366 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9367 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9369 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9370 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9371 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9373 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9374 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9375 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9376 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9377 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9379 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9380 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9381 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9382 overrides @code{nil} values of
9383 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9384 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9386 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9387 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9388 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9389 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9391 Ready-made functions include@*
9392 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9393 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9394 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9395 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9396 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9397 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9398 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9399 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9400 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9401 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9402 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9403 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9405 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9406 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9408 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9409 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9410 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9413 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9414 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9415 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9416 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9420 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9429 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9430 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9431 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9432 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9433 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9434 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9435 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9437 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9438 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9439 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9440 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9442 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9443 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9444 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9445 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9446 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9447 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9448 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9449 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9450 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9452 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9453 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9454 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9455 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9456 quoted-printable header encoding.
9458 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9459 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9460 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9464 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9467 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9468 means encode all charsets),
9470 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9471 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9472 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9479 @cindex coding system aliases
9480 @cindex preferred charset
9482 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9483 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9484 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9486 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9488 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9489 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9492 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9493 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9496 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9497 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9499 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9502 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9505 This will almost do the right thing.
9507 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9511 (codepage-setup 1251)
9512 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9516 @node Article Commands
9517 @section Article Commands
9524 @kindex A P (Summary)
9525 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9526 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9527 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9528 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9529 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9530 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9535 @node Summary Sorting
9536 @section Summary Sorting
9537 @cindex summary sorting
9539 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9540 can't really see why you'd want that.
9545 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9546 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9547 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9550 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9551 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9552 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9555 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9556 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9557 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9560 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9561 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9562 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9565 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9566 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9567 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9570 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9571 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9572 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9575 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9576 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9577 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9580 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9581 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9582 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9585 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9586 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9587 Sort using the default sorting method
9588 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9591 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9592 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9593 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9594 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9595 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9599 @node Finding the Parent
9600 @section Finding the Parent
9601 @cindex parent articles
9602 @cindex referring articles
9607 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9608 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9609 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9610 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9611 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9612 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9613 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9614 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9615 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9617 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9618 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9619 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9620 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9621 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9625 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9626 @kindex A R (Summary)
9627 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9628 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9631 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9632 @kindex A T (Summary)
9633 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9634 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9635 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9636 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9637 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9638 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9639 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9641 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9642 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9643 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9644 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9645 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9646 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9649 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9650 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9652 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9653 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
9654 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
9655 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
9656 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
9657 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9659 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
9660 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
9661 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
9664 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9665 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9666 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9667 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9668 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9669 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9672 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9673 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9674 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9677 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9678 then ask Google if that fails:
9681 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9683 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9686 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9687 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9688 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9689 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9690 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9691 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9692 not support this at all.
9695 @node Alternative Approaches
9696 @section Alternative Approaches
9698 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9699 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9702 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9703 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9708 @subsection Pick and Read
9709 @cindex pick and read
9711 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9712 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9713 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9714 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9716 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9717 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9718 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9719 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9720 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9721 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9723 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9728 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9729 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9730 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9731 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9732 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9733 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9734 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9735 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9738 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9739 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9740 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9741 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9745 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9746 Unpick the thread or article
9747 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9748 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9749 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9750 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9751 the thread or article at that line.
9755 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9756 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9757 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9758 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9759 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9760 will still be visible when you are reading.
9764 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9765 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9766 which is mapped to the same function
9767 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9769 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9772 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9775 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9776 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9778 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9779 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9780 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9782 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9783 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9784 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9785 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9786 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9787 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9788 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9792 @subsection Binary Groups
9793 @cindex binary groups
9795 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9796 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9797 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9798 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9799 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9800 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9801 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9804 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9805 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9806 command, when you have turned on this mode
9807 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9809 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9810 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9814 @section Tree Display
9817 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9818 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9819 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9820 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9823 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9826 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9827 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9828 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9830 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9831 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9832 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9833 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9834 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9836 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9837 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9838 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9839 default is @code{modeline}.
9841 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9842 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9843 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9844 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9845 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9846 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9847 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9853 The name of the poster.
9855 The @code{From} header.
9857 The number of the article.
9859 The opening bracket.
9861 The closing bracket.
9866 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9868 Variables related to the display are:
9871 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9872 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9873 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9874 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9876 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9877 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9878 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9880 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9882 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9883 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9884 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9885 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9889 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9890 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9891 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
9892 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
9893 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9894 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9895 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9896 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9897 other windows displayed next to it.
9899 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9903 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9904 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9907 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9908 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9909 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9910 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9911 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9912 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
9913 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
9917 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
9920 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
9930 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
9935 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
9936 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
9938 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
9940 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
9946 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
9947 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
9948 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
9951 (setq gnus-use-trees t
9952 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9953 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
9954 (gnus-add-configuration
9958 (summary 0.75 point)
9963 @xref{Window Layout}.
9966 @node Mail Group Commands
9967 @section Mail Group Commands
9968 @cindex mail group commands
9970 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
9971 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
9973 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
9974 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9979 @kindex B e (Summary)
9980 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
9981 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
9982 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
9983 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
9984 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
9987 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
9988 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
9989 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
9990 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
9991 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
9992 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
9995 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
9996 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
9997 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
9998 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
9999 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10000 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10003 @kindex B m (Summary)
10005 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10006 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10007 Move the article from one mail group to another
10008 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10009 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10012 @kindex B c (Summary)
10014 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10015 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10016 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10017 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10018 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10021 @kindex B B (Summary)
10022 @cindex crosspost mail
10023 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10024 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10025 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10026 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10027 be properly updated.
10030 @kindex B i (Summary)
10031 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10032 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10033 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10034 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10037 @kindex B I (Summary)
10038 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10039 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10040 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10041 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10044 @kindex B r (Summary)
10045 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10046 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10047 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10048 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10049 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10050 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10051 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10052 (which is the default).
10056 @kindex B w (Summary)
10057 @kindex e (Summary)
10058 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10059 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10060 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10061 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10062 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10063 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10064 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10067 @kindex B q (Summary)
10068 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10069 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10070 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10071 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10074 @kindex B t (Summary)
10075 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10076 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10077 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10080 @kindex B p (Summary)
10081 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10082 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10083 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10084 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10085 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10086 article from your news server (or rather, from
10087 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10088 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10089 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10090 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10091 just not have arrived yet.
10094 @kindex K E (Summary)
10095 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10096 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10097 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10098 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10099 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10103 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10104 @cindex moving articles
10105 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10106 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10107 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10108 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10109 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10110 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10111 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10114 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10115 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10116 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10117 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10121 @node Various Summary Stuff
10122 @section Various Summary Stuff
10125 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10126 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10127 * Summary Generation Commands::
10128 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10132 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10133 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10134 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10135 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10136 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10137 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10139 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10140 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10141 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10144 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10145 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10146 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10148 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10149 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10150 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10151 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10152 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10153 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10156 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10157 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10158 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10159 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10160 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10162 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10163 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10164 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10167 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10168 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10169 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10170 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10171 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10172 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10173 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10174 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10175 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10176 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10178 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10179 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10180 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10181 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10182 list of articles to be selected.
10184 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10185 the list in one particular group:
10188 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10189 (if (string= group "some.group")
10190 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10194 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10195 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10196 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10197 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10198 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10201 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10202 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10203 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10204 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10205 variable will be used instead.
10207 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10208 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10209 buffers. For example:
10212 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10213 '(message-use-followup-to
10214 (gnus-visible-headers .
10215 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10218 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10222 @node Summary Group Information
10223 @subsection Summary Group Information
10228 @kindex H f (Summary)
10229 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10230 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10231 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10232 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10233 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10234 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10235 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10236 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10237 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10240 @kindex H d (Summary)
10241 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10242 Give a brief description of the current group
10243 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10244 rereading the description from the server.
10247 @kindex H h (Summary)
10248 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10249 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10250 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10253 @kindex H i (Summary)
10254 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10255 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10259 @node Searching for Articles
10260 @subsection Searching for Articles
10265 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10266 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10267 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10268 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10271 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10272 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10273 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10274 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10277 @kindex & (Summary)
10278 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10279 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10280 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10281 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10282 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10283 search backward instead.
10285 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10286 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10289 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10290 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10291 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10292 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10295 @node Summary Generation Commands
10296 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10301 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10302 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10303 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10306 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10307 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10308 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10309 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10312 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10313 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10314 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10315 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10320 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10321 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10327 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10328 @kindex A D (Summary)
10329 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10330 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10331 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10332 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10333 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10334 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10335 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10336 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10340 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10341 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10342 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10343 several documents into one biiig group
10344 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10345 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10346 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10347 command understands the process/prefix convention
10348 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10351 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10352 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10353 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10354 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10355 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10356 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10359 @kindex = (Summary)
10360 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10361 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10362 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10365 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10366 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10367 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10368 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10371 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10372 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10373 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10374 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10379 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10380 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10381 @cindex summary exit
10382 @cindex exiting groups
10384 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10385 group and return you to the group buffer.
10392 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10393 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10394 @kindex q (Summary)
10395 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10396 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10397 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10398 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10399 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10400 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10401 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10402 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10403 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10404 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10405 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10406 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10410 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10411 @kindex Q (Summary)
10412 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10413 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10414 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10418 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10419 @kindex c (Summary)
10420 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10421 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10422 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10423 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10426 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10427 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10428 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10429 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10432 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10433 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10434 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10435 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10439 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10440 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10441 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10442 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10443 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10444 all articles, both read and unread.
10448 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10449 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10450 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10451 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10452 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10453 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10454 articles, both read and unread.
10457 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10458 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10459 Exit the group and go to the next group
10460 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10463 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10464 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10465 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10466 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10469 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10470 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10471 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10472 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10473 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10474 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10477 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10478 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10479 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10480 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10482 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10483 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10484 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10485 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10486 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10487 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10488 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10489 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10490 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10491 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10492 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10493 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10495 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10497 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10498 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10499 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10500 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10501 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10502 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10503 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10504 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10505 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10508 @node Crosspost Handling
10509 @section Crosspost Handling
10513 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10514 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10515 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10516 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10517 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10518 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10521 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10522 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10523 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10524 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10525 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10527 @cindex cross-posting
10529 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10530 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10531 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10532 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10533 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10534 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10535 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10536 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10537 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10538 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10539 the cross reference mechanism.
10541 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10542 @cindex overview.fmt
10543 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10544 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10545 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10546 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10547 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10548 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10551 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10552 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10553 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10558 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10561 @node Duplicate Suppression
10562 @section Duplicate Suppression
10564 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10565 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10566 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10567 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10572 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10573 is evil and not very common.
10576 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10577 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10580 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10581 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10584 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10587 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10588 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10590 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10591 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10592 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10593 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10594 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10595 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10596 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10599 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10600 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10601 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10602 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10603 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10604 saw the article in.
10607 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10608 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10609 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10611 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10612 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10613 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10614 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10615 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10616 session are suppressed.
10618 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10619 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10620 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10621 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10623 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10624 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10625 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10626 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10629 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10630 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10631 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10632 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10633 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10634 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10635 to you to figure out, I think.
10640 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10641 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10642 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10647 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10648 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10649 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10650 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10653 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10654 or newer is recommended.
10658 More information on how to set things up can be found in the message
10659 manual (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10662 @item mm-verify-option
10663 @vindex mm-verify-option
10664 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10665 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10666 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10668 @item mm-decrypt-option
10669 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10670 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10671 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10672 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10675 @vindex mml1991-use
10676 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10677 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10678 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10682 @vindex mml2015-use
10683 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10684 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10685 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10690 @cindex snarfing keys
10691 @cindex importing PGP keys
10692 @cindex PGP key ring import
10693 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10694 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10695 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10696 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10697 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10698 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10699 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10700 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10701 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10704 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10707 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10708 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10711 @section Mailing List
10712 @cindex mailing list
10715 @kindex A M (summary)
10716 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10717 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10718 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10719 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10722 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10727 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10728 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10729 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10732 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10733 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10734 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10737 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10738 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10739 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10743 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10744 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10745 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10748 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10749 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10750 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10753 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10754 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10755 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10760 @node Article Buffer
10761 @chapter Article Buffer
10762 @cindex article buffer
10764 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10765 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10766 tell Gnus otherwise.
10769 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10770 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10771 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10772 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10773 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10777 @node Hiding Headers
10778 @section Hiding Headers
10779 @cindex hiding headers
10780 @cindex deleting headers
10782 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10783 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10785 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10786 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10787 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10788 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10789 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10790 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10791 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10792 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10793 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10795 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10799 @item gnus-visible-headers
10800 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10801 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10802 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10803 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10805 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10806 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10809 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10812 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10815 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10816 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10817 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10818 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10819 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10820 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10822 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10823 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10826 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10829 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10832 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10833 variable will have no effect.
10837 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10838 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10839 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10840 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10841 the headers are to be displayed.
10843 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10844 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10847 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10850 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10851 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10853 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10854 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10855 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10856 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10857 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10858 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10859 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10862 These conditions are:
10865 Remove all empty headers.
10867 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10868 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10870 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10871 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10874 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10877 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10878 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
10880 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10881 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10883 Remove the @code{CC} header if it only contains the address identical to
10884 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10886 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10889 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
10891 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
10894 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10897 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
10898 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
10901 This is also the default value for this variable.
10905 @section Using MIME
10906 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
10908 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
10909 while people stand around yawning.
10911 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
10912 while all newsreaders die of fear.
10914 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
10915 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
10916 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
10918 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
10919 @findex gnus-display-mime
10920 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
10921 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
10922 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
10923 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
10925 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
10926 @acronym{MIME} button:
10929 @findex gnus-article-press-button
10930 @item RET (Article)
10931 @kindex RET (Article)
10932 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
10933 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
10934 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
10935 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
10936 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
10937 object is displayed inline.
10939 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
10940 @item M-RET (Article)
10941 @kindex M-RET (Article)
10943 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10944 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
10946 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
10948 @kindex t (Article)
10949 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
10950 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
10952 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
10954 @kindex C (Article)
10955 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10956 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
10958 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
10960 @kindex o (Article)
10961 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
10962 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
10964 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
10965 @item C-o (Article)
10966 @kindex C-o (Article)
10967 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
10968 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
10969 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
10970 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
10971 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
10972 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
10974 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
10976 @kindex d (Article)
10977 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
10978 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
10979 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
10981 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
10983 @kindex c (Article)
10984 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
10985 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
10986 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
10987 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
10988 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
10990 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
10992 @kindex p (Article)
10993 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
10994 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
10995 @file{.mailcap} file.
10997 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
10999 @kindex i (Article)
11000 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11001 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
11002 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11003 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11004 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11007 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11009 @kindex E (Article)
11010 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11011 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11012 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11014 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11016 @kindex e (Article)
11017 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11018 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11020 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11022 @kindex | (Article)
11023 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11025 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11027 @kindex . (Article)
11028 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11029 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11033 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11034 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11035 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11037 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11038 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11039 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11040 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11041 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11042 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11043 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11044 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11045 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11047 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11049 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11052 @node Customizing Articles
11053 @section Customizing Articles
11054 @cindex article customization
11056 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11057 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11058 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11059 called automatically when you select the articles.
11061 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11062 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11063 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11064 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11066 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11067 for sensible values.
11071 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11074 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11077 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11080 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11083 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11087 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11088 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11089 regexps in the list.
11092 A list where the first element is not a string:
11094 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11095 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11096 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11100 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11105 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11106 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11107 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11108 considered to contain just a single part.
11110 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11111 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11112 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11113 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11114 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11115 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11116 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11118 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11119 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11120 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11121 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11124 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11125 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11127 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11129 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11130 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11131 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11132 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11133 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11134 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11135 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11136 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11137 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11138 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11140 @xref{Article Washing}.
11142 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11143 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11144 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11145 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11146 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11147 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11148 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11150 @xref{Article Date}.
11152 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11153 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11154 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11158 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11160 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11162 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11163 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11164 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11168 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11172 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11176 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11177 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11178 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11179 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11180 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11181 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11182 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11183 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11184 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11185 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11187 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11189 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11190 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11191 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11193 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11195 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11196 @item gnus-treat-translate
11197 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11199 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11200 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11201 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11202 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11204 @xref{Article Header}.
11209 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11210 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11211 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11212 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11213 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11217 @node Article Keymap
11218 @section Article Keymap
11220 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11221 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11222 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11223 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11226 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11231 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11232 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11233 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11234 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11237 @kindex DEL (Article)
11238 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11239 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11240 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11243 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11244 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11245 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11246 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11247 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11250 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11251 @findex gnus-article-mail
11252 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11253 given a prefix, include the mail.
11256 @kindex s (Article)
11257 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11258 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11259 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11262 @kindex ? (Article)
11263 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11264 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11265 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11268 @kindex TAB (Article)
11269 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11270 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11271 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11274 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11275 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11276 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11279 @kindex R (Article)
11280 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11281 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11282 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11283 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11287 @kindex F (Article)
11288 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11289 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11290 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11291 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11299 @section Misc Article
11303 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11304 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11305 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11306 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11309 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11310 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11311 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11312 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11313 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11315 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11316 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11317 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11318 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11319 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11320 the contents of the article buffer.
11322 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11323 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11324 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11326 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11327 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11328 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11329 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11331 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11332 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11333 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11334 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11336 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11337 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11338 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11339 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11340 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11341 with two extensions:
11346 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11347 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11348 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11353 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11356 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11359 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11360 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11361 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11364 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11367 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11370 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11375 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11379 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11381 @item gnus-break-pages
11382 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11383 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11384 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11385 paging will not be done.
11387 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11388 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11389 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11393 @cindex internationalized domain names
11394 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11395 @item gnus-use-idna
11396 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11397 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11398 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11399 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11400 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11405 @node Composing Messages
11406 @chapter Composing Messages
11407 @cindex composing messages
11410 @cindex sending mail
11415 @cindex using s/mime
11416 @cindex using smime
11418 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11419 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11420 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11421 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11422 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11423 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11426 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11427 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11428 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11429 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11430 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11431 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11432 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11433 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11434 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11437 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11438 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11444 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11447 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11448 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11449 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11450 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11451 @code{nil} include all headers.
11453 @item gnus-add-to-list
11454 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11455 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11456 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11458 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11459 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11460 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
11461 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
11462 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
11463 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
11464 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
11465 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
11467 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11468 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
11470 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11471 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11472 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11473 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11474 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11479 @node Posting Server
11480 @section Posting Server
11482 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11483 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11485 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11487 It can be quite complicated.
11489 @vindex gnus-post-method
11490 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11491 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11492 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11493 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11494 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11495 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11496 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11497 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11498 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11501 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11504 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11505 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11506 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11507 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11509 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11510 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11512 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11513 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11516 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11517 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11519 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11520 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11521 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11522 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11523 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11524 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11525 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11526 package correctly. An example:
11529 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11530 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11533 To the thing similar to this, there is
11534 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11535 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11536 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11538 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11539 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11540 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11542 @node POP before SMTP
11543 @section POP before SMTP
11544 @cindex pop before smtp
11545 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11546 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11548 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11549 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11550 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11551 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11552 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11555 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11556 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11560 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11561 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11562 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11563 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11564 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11565 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11566 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11567 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11569 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11570 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11571 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11572 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11573 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11574 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11577 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11578 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11579 :password "secret"))
11583 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11584 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11587 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11589 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11590 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11591 :password "secret")))
11592 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11595 @node Mail and Post
11596 @section Mail and Post
11598 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11602 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11603 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11604 @cindex mailing lists
11606 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11607 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11608 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11609 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11610 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11611 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11612 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11613 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11614 still a pain, though.
11616 @item gnus-user-agent
11617 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11620 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11621 User-Agent header. It can be one of the symbols @code{gnus} (show only
11622 Gnus version), @code{emacs-gnus} (show only Emacs and Gnus versions),
11623 @code{emacs-gnus-config} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus system
11624 configuration), @code{emacs-gnus-type} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus
11625 system type) or a custom string. If you set it to a string, be sure to
11626 use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11630 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11631 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11632 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11635 @findex ispell-message
11637 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11640 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11641 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11644 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11648 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11649 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11651 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11654 Modify to suit your needs.
11657 @node Archived Messages
11658 @section Archived Messages
11659 @cindex archived messages
11660 @cindex sent messages
11662 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11663 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11664 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11665 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11668 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11669 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11672 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11673 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11674 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11677 (nnfolder "archive"
11678 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11679 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11680 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11681 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11684 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11685 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11686 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11687 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11690 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11691 '(nnfolder "archive"
11692 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11693 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11694 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11697 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11699 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11700 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11701 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11703 This variable can be used to do the following:
11707 Messages will be saved in that group.
11709 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11710 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11711 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11712 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11713 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11714 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11715 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11716 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11719 @item a list of strings
11720 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11722 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11723 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11726 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11731 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11733 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11736 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11738 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11741 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11743 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11744 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11745 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11746 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11749 More complex stuff:
11751 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11752 '((if (message-news-p)
11757 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11758 messages in one file per month:
11761 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11762 '((if (message-news-p)
11764 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11767 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11768 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11770 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11771 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11772 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11773 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11774 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11775 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11776 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11777 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11778 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11779 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11781 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11782 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11783 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11784 this will disable archiving.
11787 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11788 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11789 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11790 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11791 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11794 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11795 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11796 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
11799 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
11800 but the latter is the preferred method.
11802 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11803 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11804 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
11806 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11807 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11808 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
11809 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
11810 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
11811 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
11812 changed in the future.
11817 @node Posting Styles
11818 @section Posting Styles
11819 @cindex posting styles
11822 All them variables, they make my head swim.
11824 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
11825 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
11826 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
11829 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
11830 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
11831 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
11832 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
11833 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
11838 (signature "Peace and happiness")
11839 (organization "What me?"))
11841 (signature "Death to everybody"))
11842 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
11843 (organization "Emacs is it")))
11846 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
11847 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
11848 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
11849 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
11850 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
11851 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
11852 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
11853 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
11855 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
11856 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
11857 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
11858 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
11859 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
11860 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
11861 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
11862 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
11863 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
11864 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
11865 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
11866 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
11867 said to @dfn{match}.
11869 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
11870 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
11871 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
11872 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
11873 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
11874 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
11875 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
11876 name can be one of:
11879 @item @code{signature}
11880 @item @code{signature-file}
11881 @item @code{x-face-file}
11882 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
11883 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
11887 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
11888 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
11889 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
11890 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
11891 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
11893 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
11894 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
11895 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
11896 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
11897 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
11898 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
11899 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
11900 references chars lines xref extra.
11902 @vindex message-reply-headers
11904 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
11905 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
11906 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
11908 @findex message-mail-p
11909 @findex message-news-p
11911 So here's a new example:
11914 (setq gnus-posting-styles
11916 (signature-file "~/.signature")
11918 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
11919 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
11920 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
11922 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
11923 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
11924 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
11925 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
11926 (signature my-news-signature))
11927 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
11928 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
11929 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
11930 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
11931 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
11932 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
11933 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
11934 (address "user@@bar.foo")
11935 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
11936 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
11938 (From (save-excursion
11939 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
11940 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
11942 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
11945 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
11946 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
11947 if you fill many roles.
11954 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
11955 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
11956 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
11957 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
11958 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
11960 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
11961 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
11962 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
11963 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
11964 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
11968 @vindex nndraft-directory
11969 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
11970 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
11971 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
11972 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
11973 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
11974 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
11976 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
11977 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
11978 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
11979 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
11980 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
11981 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
11982 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
11983 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
11984 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
11986 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
11987 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
11988 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
11989 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
11990 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
11991 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
11992 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
11993 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
11994 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
11995 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
11996 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
11997 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
11998 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
11999 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12001 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12002 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12003 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12005 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12006 @kindex D e (Draft)
12007 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12008 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12009 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12011 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12014 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12015 @kindex D s (Draft)
12016 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12017 @kindex D S (Draft)
12018 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12019 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12020 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12021 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12022 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12025 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12026 @kindex D t (Draft)
12027 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12028 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12029 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12032 @node Rejected Articles
12033 @section Rejected Articles
12034 @cindex rejected articles
12036 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12037 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12038 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12039 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12041 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12042 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12043 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12044 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12045 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12047 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12048 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12049 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12051 @node Signing and encrypting
12052 @section Signing and encrypting
12054 @cindex using s/mime
12055 @cindex using smime
12057 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12058 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12059 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12060 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12062 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12063 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12064 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12065 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12066 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12067 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12068 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12069 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12070 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12071 automatically encrypted messages.
12073 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12074 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12075 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12080 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12081 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12083 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12086 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12087 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12089 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12092 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12093 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12095 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12098 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12099 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12101 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12104 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12105 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12107 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12110 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12111 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12113 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12116 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12117 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12118 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12122 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12124 @node Select Methods
12125 @chapter Select Methods
12126 @cindex foreign groups
12127 @cindex select methods
12129 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12130 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12131 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12132 personal mail group.
12134 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12135 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12136 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12137 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12138 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12139 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12141 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12142 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12144 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12147 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12148 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12149 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12150 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12151 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12153 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12156 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12157 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12158 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12159 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12160 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12161 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12162 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12163 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12167 @node Server Buffer
12168 @section Server Buffer
12170 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12171 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12172 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12173 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12174 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12175 back end represents a virtual server.
12177 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12178 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12179 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12180 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12182 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12183 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12184 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12185 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12186 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12187 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12188 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12190 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12191 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12194 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12195 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12196 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12197 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12198 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12199 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12200 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12203 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12204 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12207 @node Server Buffer Format
12208 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12209 @cindex server buffer format
12211 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12212 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12213 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12214 variable, with some simple extensions:
12219 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12222 The name of this server.
12225 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12228 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12231 Whether this server is agentized.
12234 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12235 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12236 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12237 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12247 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12250 @node Server Commands
12251 @subsection Server Commands
12252 @cindex server commands
12258 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12259 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12263 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12264 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12267 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12268 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12269 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12273 @findex gnus-server-exit
12274 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12278 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12279 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12283 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12284 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12288 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12289 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12293 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12294 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12298 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12299 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12300 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12305 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12306 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12307 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12308 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12313 @node Example Methods
12314 @subsection Example Methods
12316 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12319 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12322 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12328 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12329 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12332 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12333 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12335 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12336 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12340 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12343 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12344 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12346 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12347 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12348 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12352 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12355 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12358 Here's the method for a public spool:
12362 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12363 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12369 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12370 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12371 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12372 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12373 should probably look something like this:
12377 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12378 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12379 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12380 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12383 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12384 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12385 configuration to the example above:
12388 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12391 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12393 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12394 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12395 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12399 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12400 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12401 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12402 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12405 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12406 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12407 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12408 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12411 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12412 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12414 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12415 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12417 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12418 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12419 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12421 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12423 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12424 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12425 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12426 will contain the following:
12436 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12437 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12440 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12441 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12442 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12445 @node Server Variables
12446 @subsection Server Variables
12447 @cindex server variables
12448 @cindex server parameters
12450 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12451 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12452 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12453 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12454 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12456 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12457 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12458 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12459 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12460 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12461 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12462 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12463 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12464 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12468 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12469 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12470 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12473 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12475 @node Servers and Methods
12476 @subsection Servers and Methods
12478 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12479 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12480 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12481 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12485 @node Unavailable Servers
12486 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12488 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12489 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12490 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12491 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12492 actually the case or not.
12494 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12495 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12496 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12497 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12498 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12499 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12500 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12501 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12503 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12504 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12506 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12507 with the following commands:
12513 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12514 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12515 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12519 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12520 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12521 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12525 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12526 Mark the current server as unreachable
12527 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12530 @kindex M-o (Server)
12531 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12532 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12533 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12536 @kindex M-c (Server)
12537 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12538 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12539 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12543 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12544 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12545 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12549 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12550 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12556 @section Getting News
12557 @cindex reading news
12558 @cindex news back ends
12560 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12561 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12562 or it can read from a local spool.
12565 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12566 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12574 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12575 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12576 server as the, uhm, address.
12578 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12579 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12580 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12581 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12583 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12584 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12585 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12587 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12592 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12593 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12594 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12596 @cindex authentification
12597 @cindex nntp authentification
12598 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12599 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12600 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12601 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12602 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12603 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12604 present in this hook.
12606 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12607 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12608 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12609 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12610 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12611 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12612 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12613 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12614 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12615 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12616 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12617 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12621 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12624 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12626 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12627 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12628 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12629 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12630 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12631 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12632 @samp{force} is explained below.
12636 Here's an example file:
12639 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12640 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12643 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12644 have to be first, for instance.
12646 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12647 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12648 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12649 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12650 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12651 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12652 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12654 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12655 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12661 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12662 previously mentioned.
12664 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12666 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12667 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12668 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12669 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12670 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12673 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12674 '(("innd" (ding))))
12677 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12679 The default value is
12682 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12683 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12684 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12687 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12688 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12690 @item nntp-maximum-request
12691 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12692 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12693 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12694 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12695 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12696 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12697 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12699 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12700 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12701 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12702 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12703 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12704 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12705 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12706 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12707 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12708 no timeouts are done.
12710 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12711 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12712 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12713 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12716 @item nntp-xover-commands
12717 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12718 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12720 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12721 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12725 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12726 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12727 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12728 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12729 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12730 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12731 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12732 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12733 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12734 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12735 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12737 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12738 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12739 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12741 @item nntp-record-commands
12742 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12743 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12744 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12745 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12746 that doesn't seem to work.
12748 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12749 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12750 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12751 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12752 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12753 Six pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12754 two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
12755 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12757 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12758 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12759 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12760 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12761 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12762 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12763 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12766 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12769 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12770 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
12775 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
12776 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
12777 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
12781 @node Direct Functions
12782 @subsubsection Direct Functions
12783 @cindex direct connection functions
12785 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
12786 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
12787 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
12788 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12791 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
12792 @item nntp-open-network-stream
12793 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
12796 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
12797 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
12798 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12799 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
12800 installed. You then define a server as follows:
12803 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12804 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
12806 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12807 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
12808 (nntp-port-number )
12809 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12812 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
12813 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
12814 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12815 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
12816 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
12817 then define a server as follows:
12820 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12821 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
12823 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12824 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
12825 (nntp-port-number 563)
12826 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12829 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
12830 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
12831 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
12832 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
12833 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
12834 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
12835 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
12836 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
12840 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12841 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
12842 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
12845 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
12846 session, which is not a good idea.
12850 @node Indirect Functions
12851 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
12852 @cindex indirect connection functions
12854 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
12855 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12856 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
12857 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
12858 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
12859 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12862 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12863 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12864 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
12865 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
12866 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
12868 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12871 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
12872 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
12873 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
12874 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
12876 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12877 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12878 List of strings to be used as the switches to
12879 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
12880 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
12881 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
12882 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
12883 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
12887 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12888 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12889 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
12890 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
12892 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12895 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
12896 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
12897 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
12900 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
12901 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
12902 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
12903 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
12905 @item nntp-via-user-password
12906 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
12907 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
12909 @item nntp-via-envuser
12910 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
12911 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
12912 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
12913 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
12915 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
12916 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
12917 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
12918 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
12925 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
12930 @item nntp-via-user-name
12931 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
12932 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
12934 @item nntp-via-address
12935 @vindex nntp-via-address
12936 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
12941 @node Common Variables
12942 @subsubsection Common Variables
12944 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
12945 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
12946 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
12947 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
12948 variables individually).
12952 @item nntp-pre-command
12953 @vindex nntp-pre-command
12954 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
12955 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
12956 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
12957 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
12960 @vindex nntp-address
12961 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12963 @item nntp-port-number
12964 @vindex nntp-port-number
12965 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12966 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
12967 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
12968 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
12969 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
12970 not work with named ports.
12972 @item nntp-end-of-line
12973 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
12974 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
12975 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
12976 using a non native connection function.
12978 @item nntp-telnet-command
12979 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
12980 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
12981 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
12982 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12985 @item nntp-telnet-switches
12986 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
12987 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
12994 @subsection News Spool
12998 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
12999 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13000 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13003 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13004 anything else) as the address.
13006 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13007 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13008 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13009 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13013 @item nnspool-inews-program
13014 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13015 Program used to post an article.
13017 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13018 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13019 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13021 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13022 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13023 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13024 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13026 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13027 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13028 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13029 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13031 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13032 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13033 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13035 @item nnspool-active-file
13036 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13037 The name of the active file.
13039 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13040 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13041 The name of the group descriptions file.
13043 @item nnspool-history-file
13044 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13045 The name of the news history file.
13047 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13048 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13049 The name of the active date file.
13051 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13052 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13053 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13056 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13057 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13059 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13060 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13061 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13068 @section Getting Mail
13069 @cindex reading mail
13072 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13076 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13077 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13078 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13079 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13080 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13081 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13082 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13083 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13084 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13085 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13086 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13087 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13088 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13092 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13093 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13095 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13096 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13097 of a culture shock.
13099 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13100 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13102 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13103 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13104 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13105 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13107 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13109 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13110 deleted? How awful!
13112 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13113 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13114 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13115 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13118 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13119 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13120 they want to treat a message.
13122 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13123 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13124 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13125 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13126 archived somewhere else.
13128 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13129 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13130 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13131 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13132 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13134 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13135 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13136 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13138 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13139 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13142 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13143 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13144 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13145 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13146 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13148 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13149 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13150 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13151 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13152 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13153 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13157 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13158 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13160 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13161 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13162 and things will happen automatically.
13164 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13165 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13168 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13171 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13172 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13173 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13174 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13175 like any other group.
13177 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13180 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13181 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13182 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13186 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13187 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13188 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13191 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13192 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13193 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13196 @node Splitting Mail
13197 @subsection Splitting Mail
13198 @cindex splitting mail
13199 @cindex mail splitting
13200 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13202 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13203 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13204 to be split into groups.
13207 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13208 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13209 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13210 ("mail.other" "")))
13213 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13214 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13215 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13216 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13217 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13218 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13219 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13222 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13226 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13227 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13229 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13230 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13231 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13232 mail belongs in that group.
13234 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13235 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13236 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13237 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13238 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13239 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13240 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13241 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13242 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13243 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13245 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13246 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13247 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13248 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13249 thinks should carry this mail message.
13251 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13252 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13253 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13254 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13256 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13257 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13258 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13259 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13260 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13262 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13265 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13266 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13267 links. If that's the case for you, set
13268 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13269 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13271 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13272 @findex nnmail-split-history
13273 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13274 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13275 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13276 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13279 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13280 Header lines longer than the value of
13281 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13284 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13285 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13286 By default the splitting codes @acronym{MIME} decodes headers so you
13287 can match on non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. The
13288 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset} variable specifies the default
13289 charset for decoding. The behavior can be turned off completely by
13290 binding @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to @code{nil}, which is
13291 useful if you want to match articles based on the raw header data.
13293 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13294 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13295 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13296 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13297 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13298 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13299 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13300 other kinds of entries.)
13302 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13303 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13304 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13305 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13306 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13307 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13308 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13309 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13310 month's rent money.
13314 @subsection Mail Sources
13316 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13317 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13318 maildir, for instance.
13321 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13322 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13323 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13327 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13328 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13330 @cindex mail server
13333 @cindex mail source
13335 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13336 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13341 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13344 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13345 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13346 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13349 The following mail source types are available:
13353 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13359 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13360 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13361 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13365 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13368 An example file mail source:
13371 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13374 Or using the default file name:
13380 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13381 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13382 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13383 mail spool while moving the mail.
13385 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13389 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13392 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13396 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13399 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13401 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13404 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
13408 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13409 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13410 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13411 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13412 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13413 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13414 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13415 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13416 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13417 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13419 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13420 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13421 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13422 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13428 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13432 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13436 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13437 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13438 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13439 predicate are considered.
13443 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13447 An example directory mail source:
13450 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13455 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13461 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13462 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13465 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13466 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13467 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13468 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13469 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13472 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13476 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13477 the user is prompted.
13480 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13481 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13484 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13487 The valid format specifier characters are:
13491 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13492 included in this string.
13495 The name of the server.
13498 The port number of the server.
13501 The user name to use.
13504 The password to use.
13507 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13508 corresponding keywords.
13511 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13512 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13515 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13516 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13519 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13520 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13521 mail should be moved to.
13523 @item :authentication
13524 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13525 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13530 @vindex pop3-movemail
13531 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13532 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13533 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If the
13534 @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server} is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be
13535 left on the @acronym{POP} server after fetching when using
13536 @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers maintain no state
13537 information between sessions, so what the client believes is there and
13538 what is actually there may not match up. If they do not, then the whole
13539 thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13541 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server,
13542 using the default user name, and default fetcher:
13548 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13551 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13552 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13555 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13558 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13562 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13563 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13564 contains exactly one mail.
13570 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13571 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13574 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13575 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13577 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13578 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13579 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13582 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13583 from locking problems).
13587 Two example maildir mail sources:
13590 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13591 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13595 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13600 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13601 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13602 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13603 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13604 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13606 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13607 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13613 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13614 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13617 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13618 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13621 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13625 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13629 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13630 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13631 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13632 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13634 @item :authentication
13635 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13636 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13637 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13638 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13641 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13642 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13643 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13649 The valid format specifier characters are:
13653 The name of the server.
13656 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13659 The port number of the server.
13662 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13663 corresponding keywords.
13666 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13667 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13670 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13671 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13672 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13673 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13674 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13675 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13678 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13679 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13680 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13681 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13684 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13685 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13689 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13692 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13694 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13698 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13699 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13700 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13702 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13703 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13705 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13711 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13712 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13715 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13719 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13723 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13724 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13728 An example webmail source:
13731 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13733 :password "secret")
13738 @item Common Keywords
13739 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13745 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13746 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13751 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13756 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13757 useful when you use local mail and news.
13762 @subsubsection Function Interface
13764 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
13765 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
13766 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
13767 consider the following mail-source setting:
13770 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
13771 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
13774 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
13775 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
13776 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
13777 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
13778 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
13780 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
13783 @node Mail Source Customization
13784 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
13786 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
13787 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
13791 @item mail-source-crash-box
13792 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
13793 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
13794 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
13796 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
13797 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
13798 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
13799 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
13800 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
13801 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
13802 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
13803 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
13805 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13806 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13807 If non-@code{nil}, ask for for confirmation before deleting old incoming
13808 files. This variable only applies when
13809 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
13811 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
13812 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
13813 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
13815 @item mail-source-directory
13816 @vindex mail-source-directory
13817 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
13818 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
13819 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
13820 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
13822 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13823 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13824 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
13825 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
13826 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
13827 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
13830 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
13831 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
13832 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
13834 @item mail-source-movemail-program
13835 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
13836 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
13837 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
13842 @node Fetching Mail
13843 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
13845 @vindex mail-sources
13846 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
13847 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
13848 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
13849 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
13851 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
13852 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
13855 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
13856 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
13861 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13862 :password "secret")))
13865 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
13869 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
13870 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13873 :password "secret")))
13877 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
13878 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
13879 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
13880 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
13881 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
13882 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
13886 @node Mail Back End Variables
13887 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
13889 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
13893 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13894 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13895 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
13896 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
13898 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
13899 @item nnmail-split-hook
13900 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
13901 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
13902 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
13903 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
13904 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
13905 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
13906 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
13907 in the buffer will show up in any files.
13908 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
13911 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13912 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13913 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13914 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13915 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
13916 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
13917 starting to handle the new mail) and
13918 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
13919 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
13920 default file modes the new mail files get:
13923 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13924 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
13926 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13927 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
13930 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
13931 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
13932 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
13933 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
13934 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
13935 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
13936 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
13938 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
13939 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
13940 @findex delete-file
13941 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
13943 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13944 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13945 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
13946 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
13947 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
13949 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13950 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13951 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
13952 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
13953 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
13955 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
13956 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
13957 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
13962 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
13963 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
13964 @cindex mail splitting
13965 @cindex fancy mail splitting
13967 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
13968 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
13969 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
13970 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
13971 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
13972 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
13974 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
13977 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
13978 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
13979 ;; @r{from real errors.}
13980 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
13982 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
13983 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
13984 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
13985 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
13986 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
13987 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
13988 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
13989 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
13990 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
13991 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
13992 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
13993 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
13994 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
13995 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
13996 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
13997 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
13998 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14002 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14003 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14004 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14009 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14010 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14012 @c Don't fold this line.
14013 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
14014 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
14015 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
14016 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
14019 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
14020 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
14021 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
14022 @var{split} is processed.
14024 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
14025 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
14026 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
14027 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14029 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14030 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14031 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14032 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14033 stored in one or more groups.
14035 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14036 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14037 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14040 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14041 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14043 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14044 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14045 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14046 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14049 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14050 body of the messages:
14053 (defun split-on-body ()
14057 (goto-char (point-min))
14058 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14062 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14063 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14064 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14065 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14066 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14067 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14068 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14070 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14071 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14072 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14073 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14074 should return a split.
14077 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14081 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14083 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
14084 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
14085 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
14086 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
14090 (any "joe" "joemail")
14094 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
14095 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
14096 of the following three ways:
14100 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14101 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
14102 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
14103 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
14104 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
14107 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
14110 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
14111 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
14112 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
14113 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
14114 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
14117 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
14118 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
14119 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
14120 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14121 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
14122 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14123 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14126 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14127 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14128 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14129 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14130 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14131 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14132 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14136 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14138 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14139 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14141 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14144 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14145 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14146 when all this splitting is performed.
14148 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14149 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14150 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14153 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14156 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14157 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14159 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14160 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14161 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14162 groupings 1 through 9.
14164 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14165 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14166 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14167 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14168 groups when users send to an address using different case
14169 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14172 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14173 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14174 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14175 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14176 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14177 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14178 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14179 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14180 it once per thread.
14182 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14183 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14184 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14185 using the colon feature, like so:
14187 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14188 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14190 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14191 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14195 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14196 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14197 in the file specified by the variable
14198 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14199 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14200 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14201 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14202 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14203 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14204 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14205 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14206 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14207 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14208 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14209 300 kBytes in size.)
14210 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14211 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14212 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14213 messages goes into the new group.
14215 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14216 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14217 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14218 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14219 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14220 ``outgoing'' group.
14223 @node Group Mail Splitting
14224 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14225 @cindex mail splitting
14226 @cindex group mail splitting
14228 @findex gnus-group-split
14229 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14230 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14231 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14232 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14233 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14234 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14235 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14236 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14238 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14239 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14240 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14241 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14243 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14244 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14245 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14246 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14247 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14248 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14249 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14251 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14252 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14253 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14254 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14255 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14256 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14257 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14259 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14260 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14261 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14262 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14263 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14264 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14265 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14266 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14267 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14268 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14269 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14270 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14271 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14273 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14278 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14279 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14281 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14282 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14283 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14284 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14286 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14289 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14290 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14291 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14294 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14295 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14296 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14300 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14301 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14302 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14306 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14309 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14310 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14311 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14312 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14313 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14314 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14315 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14316 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14317 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14319 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14320 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14321 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14322 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14323 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14324 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14325 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14326 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14327 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14329 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14330 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14331 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14332 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14333 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14334 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14337 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14340 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14341 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14342 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14343 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14344 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14347 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14348 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14349 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14350 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14352 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14353 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14354 @cindex incorporating old mail
14355 @cindex import old mail
14357 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14358 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14359 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14362 Doing so can be quite easy.
14364 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14365 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14366 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14367 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14368 your @code{nnml} groups.
14374 Go to the group buffer.
14377 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14378 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14381 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14384 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14385 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14388 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14389 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14392 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14393 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14394 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14395 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14396 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14398 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14399 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14400 using the new mail back end.
14403 @node Expiring Mail
14404 @subsection Expiring Mail
14405 @cindex article expiry
14407 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14408 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14409 different approach to mail reading.
14411 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14412 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14413 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14414 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14415 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14416 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14419 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14420 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14421 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14422 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14423 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14424 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14425 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14426 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14427 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14429 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14430 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14431 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14432 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14433 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14434 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14435 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14438 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14439 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14440 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14441 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14442 into its own group.)
14444 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14445 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14446 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14447 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14448 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14449 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14450 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14451 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14454 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14455 Groups that match the regular expression
14456 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14457 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14458 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14460 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14461 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14462 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14463 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14464 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14466 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14468 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14469 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14470 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14473 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14474 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14475 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14476 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14477 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14479 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14480 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14483 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14484 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14487 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14488 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14490 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14491 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14492 don't really mix very well.
14494 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14495 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14496 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14497 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14500 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14501 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14502 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14503 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14506 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14508 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14510 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14512 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14514 ((string= group "important")
14520 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14521 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14523 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14524 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14525 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14528 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14529 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14531 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14532 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14533 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14534 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14535 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14536 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14537 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14538 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14539 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14540 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14541 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14542 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14543 name or @code{delete}.
14545 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14547 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14550 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14551 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14552 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14553 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14554 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14557 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14558 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14559 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14560 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14561 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14564 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14565 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14566 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14567 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14568 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14569 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14571 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14572 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14573 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14574 easier for procmail users.
14576 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14577 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14578 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14579 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14580 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14581 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14582 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14583 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14584 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14585 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14586 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14587 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14588 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14591 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14593 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14594 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14595 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14596 auto-expire turned on.
14600 @subsection Washing Mail
14601 @cindex mail washing
14602 @cindex list server brain damage
14603 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14605 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14606 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14607 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14608 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14609 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14610 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14612 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14613 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14614 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14617 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14618 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14619 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14620 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14623 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14624 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14625 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14626 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14627 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14630 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14631 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14632 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14633 Emacs running on MS machines.
14637 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14638 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14639 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14640 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14643 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14644 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14645 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14646 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14648 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14649 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14650 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14651 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14652 into a feature by documenting it.)
14654 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14655 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14656 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14657 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14658 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14659 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14660 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14663 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14664 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14667 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14668 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14671 This can also be done non-destructively with
14672 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14674 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14675 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14676 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14678 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14679 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14681 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14682 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14683 @code{References} headers.
14687 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14688 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14689 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14693 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14694 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14695 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14702 @subsection Duplicates
14704 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14705 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14706 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14707 @cindex duplicate mails
14708 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14709 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14710 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14711 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14712 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14713 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14714 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14715 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14716 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14717 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14718 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14719 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14720 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14722 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14723 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14724 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14725 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14727 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14730 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14731 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14735 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14736 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14737 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14738 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14739 (any mail "mail.misc")
14740 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14746 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14747 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14748 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14752 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14753 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14754 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14755 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14756 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14759 @node Not Reading Mail
14760 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14762 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14763 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
14764 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
14766 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
14767 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
14768 mail, which should help.
14770 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14771 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14772 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14773 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14774 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14775 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
14776 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
14777 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
14778 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
14779 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
14780 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
14782 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
14783 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
14787 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
14788 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
14790 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
14791 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
14792 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
14794 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
14795 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
14796 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
14800 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
14801 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
14802 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
14803 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
14804 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
14805 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
14806 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
14810 @node Unix Mail Box
14811 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
14813 @cindex unix mail box
14815 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14816 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14817 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
14818 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
14819 which group it belongs in.
14821 Virtual server settings:
14824 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
14825 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14826 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
14829 @item nnmbox-active-file
14830 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14831 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
14832 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
14834 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
14835 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14836 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
14837 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
14842 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
14846 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14847 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14848 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
14849 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
14850 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
14852 Virtual server settings:
14855 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
14856 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14857 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
14859 @item nnbabyl-active-file
14860 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14861 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
14862 @file{~/.rmail-active}
14864 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14865 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14866 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
14872 @subsubsection Mail Spool
14874 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
14876 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
14877 format. It should be used with some caution.
14879 @vindex nnml-directory
14880 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
14881 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
14882 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
14883 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
14885 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
14888 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
14889 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
14890 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
14891 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
14892 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
14893 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
14894 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
14895 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
14897 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
14898 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
14899 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
14900 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
14902 @cindex self contained nnml servers
14904 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
14905 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
14906 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
14907 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
14908 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
14909 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
14910 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
14911 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
14914 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
14915 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
14916 them next time it starts.
14918 Virtual server settings:
14921 @item nnml-directory
14922 @vindex nnml-directory
14923 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
14924 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
14927 @item nnml-active-file
14928 @vindex nnml-active-file
14929 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
14930 @file{~/Mail/active}.
14932 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
14933 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
14934 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
14935 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
14937 @item nnml-get-new-mail
14938 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14939 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
14942 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
14943 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
14944 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
14945 default is @code{nil}.
14947 @item nnml-nov-file-name
14948 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
14949 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
14951 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14952 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14953 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
14955 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
14956 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
14957 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
14958 default is @code{nil}.
14960 @item nnml-marks-file-name
14961 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
14962 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
14964 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
14965 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
14966 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
14971 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
14972 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
14973 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
14974 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
14975 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
14976 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
14977 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
14982 @subsubsection MH Spool
14984 @cindex mh-e mail spool
14986 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
14987 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
14988 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
14989 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
14992 Virtual server settings:
14995 @item nnmh-directory
14996 @vindex nnmh-directory
14997 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
14998 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
15001 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
15002 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15003 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
15007 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
15008 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
15009 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
15010 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
15011 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
15012 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
15013 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
15018 @subsubsection Maildir
15022 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
15023 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
15024 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15025 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15026 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15029 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15030 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15031 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15032 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15033 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15034 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15035 that appear as group in Gnus.
15037 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15038 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15039 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15041 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15042 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15043 another, and you will keep your marks.
15045 Virtual server settings:
15049 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15050 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15051 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15052 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15053 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15054 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15055 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15056 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15057 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15058 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15060 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15061 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15062 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15063 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15064 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15065 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15066 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15067 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15068 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15069 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15072 @item target-prefix
15073 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15074 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15075 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15078 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15079 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15080 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15081 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15082 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15083 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15084 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15085 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15086 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15088 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15089 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15090 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15091 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15092 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15094 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15095 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15096 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15097 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15098 @code{force} argument.
15100 @item directory-files
15101 This should be a function with the same interface as
15102 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15103 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15104 parameter is optional; the default is
15105 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15106 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15107 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15108 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15109 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15110 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15113 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15114 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15115 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15116 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15117 value is @code{nil}.
15119 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15120 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15121 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15122 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15123 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15126 @subsubsection Group parameters
15128 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15129 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15130 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15131 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15132 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15133 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15136 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15137 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15138 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15139 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15140 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15141 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15142 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15143 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15144 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15148 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15149 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15150 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15151 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15152 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
15153 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
15154 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
15155 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15156 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15157 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15158 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15159 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15160 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15163 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15165 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15167 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15168 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15169 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15170 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15171 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15172 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15173 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15174 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15175 article. So that form can refer to
15176 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15177 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
15178 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15179 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15182 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15183 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15184 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15185 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15186 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15187 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15188 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15189 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15190 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15191 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15192 contain extra copies of the articles.
15194 @item directory-files
15195 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15196 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15197 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15198 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15200 @item distrust-Lines:
15201 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15202 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15203 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15206 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15207 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15208 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15209 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15210 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15211 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15214 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15215 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15216 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15217 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15218 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15219 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15220 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15222 @item nov-cache-size
15223 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15224 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15225 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15226 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15227 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15228 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15229 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15230 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15231 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15232 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15233 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15236 @subsubsection Article identification
15237 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15238 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15239 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15240 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15241 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15242 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15243 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15244 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15245 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15246 request the article in the summary buffer.
15248 @subsubsection NOV data
15249 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15250 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15251 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15252 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15253 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15254 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15255 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15256 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15257 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15258 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15259 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15261 @subsubsection Article marks
15262 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15263 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15264 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15265 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15266 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15267 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15268 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15269 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15271 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15272 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15273 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15274 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15275 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15276 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15277 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15278 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15279 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15283 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15285 @cindex mbox folders
15286 @cindex mail folders
15288 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15289 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15290 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15291 numbers and arrival dates.
15293 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15295 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15296 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15297 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15298 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15299 Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15300 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15301 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15302 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15303 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15304 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15306 Virtual server settings:
15309 @item nnfolder-directory
15310 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15311 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15312 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15313 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15315 @item nnfolder-active-file
15316 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15317 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15319 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15320 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15321 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15322 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15324 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15325 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15326 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15327 default is @code{t}
15329 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15330 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15331 @cindex backup files
15332 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15333 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15334 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15335 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15338 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15339 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15341 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15344 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15345 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15346 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15347 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15348 extract some information from it before removing it.
15350 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15351 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15352 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15353 default is @code{nil}.
15355 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15356 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15357 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15359 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15360 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15361 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15362 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15364 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15365 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15366 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15367 default is @code{nil}.
15369 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15370 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15371 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15373 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15374 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15375 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15376 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15381 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15382 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15383 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15384 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15385 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15386 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15389 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15390 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15392 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15393 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15394 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15395 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15396 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15398 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15399 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15400 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15401 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15402 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15403 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15404 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15405 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15408 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15409 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15410 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15411 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15416 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15417 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15418 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15419 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15420 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15421 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15422 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15423 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15424 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15425 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15426 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15427 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15428 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15433 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15434 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15435 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15436 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15437 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15438 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15439 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15440 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15441 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15442 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15443 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15444 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15445 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15446 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15448 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15449 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15454 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15455 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15456 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15457 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15458 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15459 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15460 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15461 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15462 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15463 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15464 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15465 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15466 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15467 provided by the active file and overviews.
15469 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15470 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15471 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15472 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15473 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15476 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15477 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15482 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15483 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15484 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15485 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15486 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15487 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15488 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15492 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15493 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15494 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15495 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15496 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15497 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15498 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15499 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15500 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15502 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15503 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15504 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15505 friendly mail back end all over.
15509 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15510 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15513 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15514 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15515 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15516 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15517 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15518 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15519 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15520 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15523 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15524 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15525 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15526 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15527 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15528 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15529 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15530 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15531 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15532 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15533 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15535 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15536 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15537 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15538 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15539 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15542 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15543 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15544 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15545 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15546 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15547 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15548 removed in the future.
15550 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15551 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15552 on your file system.
15554 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15555 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15560 @node Browsing the Web
15561 @section Browsing the Web
15563 @cindex browsing the web
15567 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15568 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15569 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15570 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15571 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15572 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15573 even know what a news group is.
15575 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15576 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15577 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15578 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15579 you mad in the end.
15581 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15584 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15585 interfaces to these sources.
15589 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15590 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15591 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15592 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15593 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15594 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
15597 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
15598 alternatives to work.
15600 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15601 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15602 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15603 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15604 though, you should be ok.
15606 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15607 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15608 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15609 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15610 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15612 @node Archiving Mail
15613 @subsection Archiving Mail
15614 @cindex archiving mail
15615 @cindex backup of mail
15617 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15618 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15619 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15620 marks is fairly simple.
15622 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15623 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15626 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15627 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15628 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15629 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15630 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15631 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15632 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15633 before you restore the data.
15635 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15636 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15637 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15638 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15639 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15640 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15641 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15642 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15643 is unnecessary in that case.
15646 @subsection Web Searches
15651 @cindex Usenet searches
15652 @cindex searching the Usenet
15654 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15655 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15656 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15657 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15658 searches without having to use a browser.
15660 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15661 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15662 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15663 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15664 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15666 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15667 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15668 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15669 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15670 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15671 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15672 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15673 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15674 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15675 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15678 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15679 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15680 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15681 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15682 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15683 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15685 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
15686 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
15687 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
15689 Virtual server variables:
15694 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15695 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15696 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15699 @vindex nnweb-search
15700 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15702 @item nnweb-max-hits
15703 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15704 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15707 @item nnweb-type-definition
15708 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15709 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15710 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15715 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15719 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15722 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15725 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15729 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15736 @subsection Slashdot
15740 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15741 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15742 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15744 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15745 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15748 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15749 '((nnslashdot "")))
15752 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15753 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15754 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15755 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15756 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15759 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15760 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15762 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15763 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
15764 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
15765 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
15766 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
15767 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
15768 @acronym{HTML} forms.
15770 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
15773 @item nnslashdot-threaded
15774 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
15775 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
15776 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
15777 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
15778 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
15779 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
15781 @item nnslashdot-login-name
15782 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
15783 The login name to use when posting.
15785 @item nnslashdot-password
15786 @vindex nnslashdot-password
15787 The password to use when posting.
15789 @item nnslashdot-directory
15790 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
15791 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
15792 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
15794 @item nnslashdot-active-url
15795 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
15796 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
15797 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
15798 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
15800 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
15801 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
15802 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
15804 @item nnslashdot-article-url
15805 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
15806 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
15807 article. The default is
15808 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
15810 @item nnslashdot-threshold
15811 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
15812 The score threshold. The default is -1.
15814 @item nnslashdot-group-number
15815 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
15816 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
15817 updated. The default is 0.
15824 @subsection Ultimate
15826 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
15828 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
15829 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
15830 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
15831 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15833 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
15834 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
15835 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
15836 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
15837 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
15838 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
15839 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
15841 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
15844 @item nnultimate-directory
15845 @vindex nnultimate-directory
15846 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
15847 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
15852 @subsection Web Archive
15854 @cindex Web Archive
15856 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
15857 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
15858 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
15859 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
15862 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
15863 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
15864 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
15865 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
15866 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
15867 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
15868 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
15869 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
15871 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
15874 @item nnwarchive-directory
15875 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
15876 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
15877 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
15879 @item nnwarchive-login
15880 @vindex nnwarchive-login
15881 The account name on the web server.
15883 @item nnwarchive-passwd
15884 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
15885 The password for your account on the web server.
15893 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
15894 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
15895 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
15896 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
15897 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
15899 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
15900 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15902 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
15903 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
15904 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
15907 @kindex G R (Group)
15908 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
15909 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
15910 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
15911 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
15913 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
15914 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
15915 subscribe to groups.
15917 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
15918 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
15919 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
15920 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
15921 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
15922 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
15923 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
15924 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
15926 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
15927 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
15928 and a @samp{text/html} part.
15931 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
15932 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
15935 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
15936 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
15940 @defun nnrss-opml-export
15941 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
15942 @acronym{OPML} format.
15945 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
15948 @item nnrss-directory
15949 @vindex nnrss-directory
15950 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
15951 @file{~/News/rss/}.
15953 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
15954 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
15955 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
15956 data files. The default is the value of
15957 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
15958 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
15960 @item nnrss-use-local
15961 @vindex nnrss-use-local
15962 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
15963 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
15964 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
15965 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
15966 download script using @command{wget}.
15968 @item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
15969 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
15970 parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
15971 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
15972 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
15973 to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
15974 simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
15975 @samp{text/html} parts.
15978 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
15979 the summary buffer.
15982 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
15983 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
15985 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
15987 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
15988 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
15991 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
15995 (require 'browse-url)
15997 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
15999 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
16002 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
16003 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
16006 (browse-url (cdr url))
16007 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
16008 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
16010 (eval-after-load "gnus"
16011 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
16012 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
16013 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
16016 Even if you have added @code{"text/html"} to the
16017 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
16018 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
16019 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
16020 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
16021 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
16022 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
16023 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
16024 @code{nnrss} groups:
16027 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
16028 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
16030 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
16031 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
16032 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
16034 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
16037 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
16041 @node Customizing W3
16042 @subsection Customizing W3
16048 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
16049 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
16050 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
16053 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
16054 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
16055 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
16058 (eval-after-load "w3"
16060 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
16061 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
16062 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
16063 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
16065 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
16068 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
16069 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16076 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16078 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16079 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16080 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16081 specify the network address of the server.
16083 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16084 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16085 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16086 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16087 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16088 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16090 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16091 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16092 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16093 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16095 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16096 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16097 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16098 usage explained in this section.
16100 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16101 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16102 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16106 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16107 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16108 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16110 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16111 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16112 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16114 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16115 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16116 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16117 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16118 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16119 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16120 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16121 (nnimap-stream network))
16122 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16124 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16125 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16126 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16129 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16130 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16131 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16132 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16134 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16139 @item nnimap-address
16140 @vindex nnimap-address
16142 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16143 server name if not specified.
16145 @item nnimap-server-port
16146 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16147 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16149 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16152 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16153 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16156 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16157 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16158 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16159 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16160 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16161 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16162 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16164 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16165 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16166 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16169 Example server specification:
16172 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16173 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16174 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16177 @item nnimap-stream
16178 @vindex nnimap-stream
16179 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16180 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16181 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16182 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16183 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16185 Example server specification:
16188 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16189 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16192 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16196 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16197 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16199 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16201 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16202 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16205 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16206 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16208 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16209 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16211 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16213 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16216 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16217 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16218 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16219 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16220 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16221 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16222 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16223 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16224 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16227 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16228 needed. It is available from
16229 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16231 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16232 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16233 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16234 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16235 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16236 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16237 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16240 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16241 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16242 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16243 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16244 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16245 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16246 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16249 @vindex imap-shell-program
16250 @vindex imap-shell-host
16251 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16252 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16254 @item nnimap-authenticator
16255 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16257 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16258 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16260 Example server specification:
16263 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16264 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16267 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16271 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16272 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16274 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16277 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16278 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16280 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16282 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16284 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16287 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16289 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16290 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16291 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16292 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16293 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16294 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16297 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16298 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16299 running in circles yet?
16301 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16302 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16305 The possible options are:
16310 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16313 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16314 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16315 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16316 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16318 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16323 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16324 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16326 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16327 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16328 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16329 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16330 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16333 Probably the only reason for frobing this would be if you're trying
16334 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16337 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16338 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16339 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16340 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16343 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16344 as ticked for other users.
16346 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16348 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16350 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16351 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16352 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16353 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16355 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16356 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16357 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16358 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16360 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16361 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16363 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16364 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16365 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16366 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16369 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16372 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16373 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16374 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16375 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16378 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16379 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16381 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16382 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16388 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16389 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16390 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16391 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16392 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16393 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16398 @node Splitting in IMAP
16399 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16400 @cindex splitting imap mail
16402 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16403 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16404 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16405 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16406 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16410 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16411 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16412 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16414 Here are the variables of interest:
16418 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16419 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16421 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16423 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16424 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16425 found will be used.
16427 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16429 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16430 @cindex splitting, inbox
16432 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16434 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16435 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16436 splitting is disabled!
16439 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16440 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16443 No nnmail equivalent.
16445 @item nnimap-split-rule
16446 @cindex splitting, rules
16447 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16449 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16452 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16453 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16454 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16455 Neither did I, we need examples.
16458 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16460 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16461 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16462 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16465 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16466 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16467 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16469 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16470 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16474 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16477 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16478 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16480 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16481 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16482 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16483 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16485 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16486 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16487 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16488 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16489 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16490 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16492 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16493 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16494 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16496 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16497 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16498 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16500 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16502 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16503 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16504 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16507 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16508 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16509 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16510 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16511 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16512 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16515 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16516 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16517 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16518 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16519 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16520 group/function elements.
16522 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16524 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16526 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16528 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16529 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16531 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16532 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16533 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16536 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16537 @cindex splitting, fancy
16538 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16539 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16541 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16542 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16543 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16545 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16546 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16547 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16548 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16553 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16554 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16557 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16559 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16560 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16561 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16563 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16564 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16565 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16566 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
16570 @node Expiring in IMAP
16571 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16572 @cindex expiring imap mail
16574 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16575 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16576 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16577 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16578 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16579 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16582 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16583 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16584 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16585 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16586 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16587 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16588 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16589 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16593 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16594 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16596 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16597 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16599 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16601 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16602 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16603 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16604 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16608 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16609 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16610 @cindex editing imap acls
16611 @cindex Access Control Lists
16612 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16613 @kindex G l (Group)
16614 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16616 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16617 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16618 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16621 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16622 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16623 editing window with detailed instructions.
16625 Some possible uses:
16629 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16630 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16631 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16633 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16634 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16635 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16639 @node Expunging mailboxes
16640 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16644 @cindex manual expunging
16645 @kindex G x (Group)
16646 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16648 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16649 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16650 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16652 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16655 @node A note on namespaces
16656 @subsection A note on namespaces
16657 @cindex IMAP namespace
16660 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16661 by the following text in the RFC2060:
16664 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16666 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16667 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16668 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16669 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16671 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16672 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16673 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16674 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16675 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16676 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16679 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16680 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16681 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16683 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16684 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16685 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16686 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16687 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16688 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16689 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16690 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16693 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16694 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16695 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16697 @node Debugging IMAP
16698 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16699 @cindex IMAP debugging
16700 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16702 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16703 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16704 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
16705 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16707 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16708 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16709 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16710 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16711 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16712 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16713 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16717 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
16718 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
16725 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
16726 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
16727 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
16728 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
16731 @node Other Sources
16732 @section Other Sources
16734 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
16735 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
16739 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
16740 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
16741 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
16742 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
16743 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
16747 @node Directory Groups
16748 @subsection Directory Groups
16750 @cindex directory groups
16752 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
16753 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
16756 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
16757 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
16758 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
16759 back end to read directories. Big deal.
16761 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
16762 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
16763 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
16764 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
16765 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
16767 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
16769 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
16770 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
16771 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
16772 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
16775 @node Anything Groups
16776 @subsection Anything Groups
16779 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
16780 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
16781 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
16784 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
16785 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
16786 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
16787 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
16788 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
16789 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
16790 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
16791 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
16792 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
16793 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
16796 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
16797 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
16798 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
16799 in the article buffer, just as usual.
16801 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
16802 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
16803 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
16804 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
16806 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
16807 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
16808 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
16809 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
16810 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
16811 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
16812 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
16813 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
16818 @item nneething-map-file-directory
16819 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
16820 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
16821 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
16823 @item nneething-exclude-files
16824 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
16825 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
16826 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
16828 @item nneething-include-files
16829 @vindex nneething-include-files
16830 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
16831 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
16833 @item nneething-map-file
16834 @vindex nneething-map-file
16835 Name of the map files.
16839 @node Document Groups
16840 @subsection Document Groups
16842 @cindex documentation group
16845 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
16846 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
16852 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
16857 The standard Unix mbox file.
16859 @cindex MMDF mail box
16861 The MMDF mail box format.
16864 Several news articles appended into a file.
16866 @cindex rnews batch files
16868 The rnews batch transport format.
16871 Netscape mail boxes.
16874 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
16876 @item standard-digest
16877 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
16880 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
16882 @item lanl-gov-announce
16883 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
16885 @cindex forwarded messages
16886 @item rfc822-forward
16887 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
16890 The Outlook mail box.
16893 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
16896 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
16899 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
16902 An RFC934-forwarded message.
16908 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
16911 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
16917 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
16918 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
16919 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
16922 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
16923 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
16924 group. And that's it.
16926 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
16927 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
16928 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
16929 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
16930 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
16931 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
16932 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
16933 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
16934 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
16935 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
16937 Virtual server variables:
16940 @item nndoc-article-type
16941 @vindex nndoc-article-type
16942 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
16943 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
16944 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
16945 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
16946 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
16948 @item nndoc-post-type
16949 @vindex nndoc-post-type
16950 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
16951 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
16956 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
16960 @node Document Server Internals
16961 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
16963 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
16964 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
16965 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
16966 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
16968 First, here's an example document type definition:
16972 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
16973 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
16976 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
16977 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
16978 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
16979 types can be defined with very few settings:
16982 @item first-article
16983 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
16984 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
16987 @item article-begin
16988 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
16989 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
16990 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
16991 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
16993 @item article-begin-function
16994 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
16995 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
16998 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
16999 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17000 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17002 @item head-begin-function
17003 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17004 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17007 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17008 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17011 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17012 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17013 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17015 @item body-begin-function
17016 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17017 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17020 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17021 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17022 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17024 @item body-end-function
17025 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17026 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17029 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17030 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17033 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17034 regexp will be totally ignored.
17038 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17039 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17040 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17041 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17042 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17045 @item prepare-body-function
17046 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17047 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17048 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17050 @item article-transform-function
17051 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17052 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17053 body of the article.
17055 @item generate-head-function
17056 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17057 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17058 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17059 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17061 @item generate-article-function
17062 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17063 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17064 parameter when requesting all articles.
17066 @item dissection-function
17067 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17068 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17069 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17070 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17071 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17072 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17076 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17081 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17082 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17083 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17084 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17085 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17086 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17087 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17088 (subtype digest guess))
17091 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17092 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17093 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17094 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17095 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17097 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17098 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17099 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17100 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17101 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17102 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17103 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17104 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17105 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17106 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17107 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17108 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17116 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
17117 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
17118 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
17120 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
17121 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
17122 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
17125 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
17126 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17127 that interested in doing things properly.
17129 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17130 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17133 First some terminology:
17138 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17139 get news and/or mail from.
17142 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17143 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17146 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17150 @item message packets
17151 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17152 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17153 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17155 @item response packets
17156 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17157 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17158 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17168 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17169 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17170 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17171 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17174 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17177 You put the packet in your home directory.
17180 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17181 the native or secondary server.
17184 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17185 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17188 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17192 You transfer this packet to the server.
17195 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17198 You then repeat until you die.
17202 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17203 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17206 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17207 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17208 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17212 @node SOUP Commands
17213 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17215 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17219 @kindex G s b (Group)
17220 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17221 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17222 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17223 process/prefix convention.
17226 @kindex G s w (Group)
17227 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17228 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17231 @kindex G s s (Group)
17232 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17233 Send all replies from the replies packet
17234 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17237 @kindex G s p (Group)
17238 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17239 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17242 @kindex G s r (Group)
17243 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17244 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17247 @kindex O s (Summary)
17248 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17249 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17250 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17251 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17256 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17261 @item gnus-soup-directory
17262 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17263 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17264 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17266 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17267 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17268 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17269 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17271 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17272 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17273 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17274 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17276 @item gnus-soup-packer
17277 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17278 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17279 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17281 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17282 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17283 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17284 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17286 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17287 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17288 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17290 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17291 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17292 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17293 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17299 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17302 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17303 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17304 you can read them at leisure.
17306 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17310 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17311 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17312 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17313 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17315 @item nnsoup-directory
17316 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17317 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17318 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17320 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17321 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17322 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17323 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17325 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17326 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17327 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17328 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17329 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17331 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17332 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17333 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17334 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17336 @item nnsoup-active-file
17337 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17338 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17339 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17340 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17341 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17343 @item nnsoup-packer
17344 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17345 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17346 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17348 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17349 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17350 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17351 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17353 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17354 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17355 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17358 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17359 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17360 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17363 @item nnsoup-always-save
17364 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17365 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17371 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17373 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17374 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17375 more for that to happen.
17377 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17378 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17379 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17382 In specific, this is what it does:
17385 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17386 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17389 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17390 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17391 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17394 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17395 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17396 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17399 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17400 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17401 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17403 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17409 @item nngateway-address
17410 @vindex nngateway-address
17411 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17413 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17414 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17415 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17416 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17417 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17418 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17419 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17422 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17423 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17424 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17427 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17430 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17433 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17436 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17438 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17441 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17442 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17443 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17445 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17447 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17448 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17449 @code{nngateway-address}.
17457 (setq gnus-post-method
17459 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17460 (nngateway-header-transformation
17461 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17464 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17467 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17472 @node Combined Groups
17473 @section Combined Groups
17475 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17479 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17480 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17484 @node Virtual Groups
17485 @subsection Virtual Groups
17487 @cindex virtual groups
17488 @cindex merging groups
17490 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17493 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17494 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17495 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17497 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17498 regexp to match component groups.
17500 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17501 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17502 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17503 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17504 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17505 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17506 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17507 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17509 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17510 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17513 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17516 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17517 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17519 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17520 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17521 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17522 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17525 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17528 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17529 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17530 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17532 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17533 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17534 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17535 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17536 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17538 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17539 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17540 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17542 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17543 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17544 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17545 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17546 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17547 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17548 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17549 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17550 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17551 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17552 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17554 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17555 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17556 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17557 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17558 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17559 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17560 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17562 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17563 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17565 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17566 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17570 @node Kibozed Groups
17571 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17575 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17576 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17577 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17578 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17580 @kindex G k (Group)
17581 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17584 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17585 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17586 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17587 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17589 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17590 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17591 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17593 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17594 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17595 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17596 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17597 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17598 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17599 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17600 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17602 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17603 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17604 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17605 Stranger things have happened.
17607 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17608 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17610 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17611 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17612 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17613 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17614 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17615 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17616 component articles.
17618 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17619 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17622 @node Gnus Unplugged
17623 @section Gnus Unplugged
17628 @cindex Gnus unplugged
17630 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
17631 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
17632 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
17633 read news. Believe it or not.
17635 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
17636 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
17637 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
17638 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
17639 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
17641 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
17642 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
17643 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
17644 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
17645 reading news on a machine.
17647 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
17648 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
17650 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
17653 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
17654 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
17655 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
17656 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
17657 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
17658 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
17659 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
17660 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
17661 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
17662 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
17663 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
17664 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
17665 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
17670 @subsection Agent Basics
17672 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
17674 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
17675 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
17676 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
17677 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
17679 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
17680 connected to the net continuously.
17682 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
17683 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
17685 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
17686 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
17687 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
17688 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
17689 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
17691 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
17692 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
17693 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
17694 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
17695 they're kinda like plugged always).
17697 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
17698 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
17699 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
17702 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
17703 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
17704 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
17705 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
17706 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
17708 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
17713 @findex gnus-unplugged
17714 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
17715 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
17716 already fetched while in this mode.
17719 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
17720 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
17721 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
17722 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
17723 Source Specifiers}).
17726 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
17727 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
17728 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
17729 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
17730 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
17733 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
17734 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
17735 then you read the news offline.
17738 And then you go to step 2.
17741 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
17747 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
17748 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
17749 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
17750 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
17751 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
17752 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
17753 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
17754 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
17757 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
17758 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
17759 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
17760 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
17762 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
17763 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
17764 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
17765 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
17766 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
17767 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
17771 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
17775 @node Agent Categories
17776 @subsection Agent Categories
17778 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
17779 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
17780 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
17781 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
17782 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
17783 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
17784 you're interested in the articles anyway.
17786 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
17787 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
17788 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
17789 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
17790 buffer for creating and managing categories.
17792 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
17793 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
17794 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
17795 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
17796 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
17799 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
17800 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
17801 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
17802 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
17803 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
17804 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
17808 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
17809 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
17810 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
17814 @node Category Syntax
17815 @subsubsection Category Syntax
17817 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
17818 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
17819 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
17822 @cindex Agent Parameters
17824 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
17825 The name of the category.
17827 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
17828 The list of groups that are in this category.
17830 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
17831 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
17832 are eligible for downloading; and
17834 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
17835 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
17836 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
17837 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
17839 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
17840 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
17841 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
17842 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
17843 only groups that should not be expired.
17845 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
17846 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
17847 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
17849 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
17850 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
17852 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
17853 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
17855 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
17856 an integer that overrides the value of
17857 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
17859 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
17860 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
17862 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
17863 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
17864 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17865 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
17866 @c all other symbols disable them.
17868 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
17869 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
17870 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17871 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
17872 all other symbols enable them.
17875 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
17878 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
17879 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
17880 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
17883 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
17884 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
17885 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
17886 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
17888 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
17889 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
17890 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
17892 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
17893 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
17894 operators sprinkled in between.
17896 Perhaps some examples are in order.
17898 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
17899 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
17905 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
17906 short (for some value of ``short'').
17908 Here's a more complex predicate:
17917 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
17918 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
17921 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
17922 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
17923 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
17925 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
17926 you want to do, you can write your own.
17928 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
17929 bound to the value determined by calling
17930 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
17931 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
17932 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
17933 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
17934 predicate to individual groups.
17938 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
17939 lines; default 100.
17942 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
17943 lines; default 200.
17946 True iff the article has a download score less than
17947 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
17950 True iff the article has a download score greater than
17951 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
17954 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
17955 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
17956 checksum and sees whether articles match.
17965 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
17966 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
17967 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
17970 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
17971 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
17972 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
17973 something along the lines of the following:
17976 (defun my-article-old-p ()
17977 "Say whether an article is old."
17978 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
17979 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
17982 with the predicate then defined as:
17985 (not my-article-old-p)
17988 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
17989 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
17993 (require 'gnus-agent)
17994 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
17995 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
17996 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
17999 and simply specify your predicate as:
18005 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18006 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18007 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18008 just don't give a damn.
18010 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18011 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18012 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18013 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18014 parameters like so:
18017 (agent-predicate . short)
18020 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18021 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18022 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18024 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18027 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18030 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18031 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18032 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18035 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18036 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18037 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18038 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18039 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18040 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18042 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18043 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18044 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18045 if it's to be specific to that group.
18047 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18054 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18055 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18061 Category specification
18065 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18071 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18074 (agent-score ("from"
18075 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18080 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18086 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18087 keywords stated above.
18093 Category specification
18096 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18102 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18106 Group Parameter specification
18109 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18112 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18117 Use @code{normal} score files
18119 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18120 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18121 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18122 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18124 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18125 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18126 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18127 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18131 Category Specification
18138 Group Parameter specification
18141 (agent-score . file)
18146 @node Category Buffer
18147 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18149 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18150 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18151 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18153 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18157 @kindex q (Category)
18158 @findex gnus-category-exit
18159 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18162 @kindex e (Category)
18163 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18164 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18165 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18168 @kindex k (Category)
18169 @findex gnus-category-kill
18170 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18173 @kindex c (Category)
18174 @findex gnus-category-copy
18175 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18178 @kindex a (Category)
18179 @findex gnus-category-add
18180 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18183 @kindex p (Category)
18184 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18185 Edit the predicate of the current category
18186 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18189 @kindex g (Category)
18190 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18191 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18192 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18195 @kindex s (Category)
18196 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18197 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18198 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18201 @kindex l (Category)
18202 @findex gnus-category-list
18203 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18207 @node Category Variables
18208 @subsubsection Category Variables
18211 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18212 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18213 Hook run in category buffers.
18215 @item gnus-category-line-format
18216 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18217 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18218 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18222 The name of the category.
18225 The number of groups in the category.
18228 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18229 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18230 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18232 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18233 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18234 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18236 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18237 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18238 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18240 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18241 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18242 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18245 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18246 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18247 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18250 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18251 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18252 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18253 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18254 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18255 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18256 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18257 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18261 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18262 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18263 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18264 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18265 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18266 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18267 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18272 @node Agent Commands
18273 @subsection Agent Commands
18274 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18275 @kindex J j (Agent)
18277 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18278 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18279 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18283 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18284 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18285 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18291 @node Group Agent Commands
18292 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18296 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18297 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18298 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18299 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18302 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18303 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18304 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18307 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18308 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18309 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18310 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18313 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18314 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18315 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18316 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18319 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18320 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18321 Add the current group to an Agent category
18322 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18323 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18326 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18327 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18328 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18329 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18330 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18333 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18334 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18335 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18341 @node Summary Agent Commands
18342 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18346 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18347 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18348 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18351 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18352 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18353 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18354 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18358 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18359 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18360 Toggle whether to download the article
18361 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18365 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18366 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18367 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18370 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18371 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18372 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18373 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18376 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18377 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
18378 Download all processable articles in this group.
18379 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
18382 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18383 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18384 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18385 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18390 @node Server Agent Commands
18391 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18395 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18396 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18397 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18398 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18401 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18402 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18403 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18404 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18409 @node Agent Visuals
18410 @subsection Agent Visuals
18412 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18413 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18414 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18415 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18416 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18417 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18418 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18419 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18420 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18421 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18423 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18424 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18425 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18426 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18427 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18428 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18429 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18430 articles will be available when unplugged.
18432 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18433 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18434 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18435 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18436 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18437 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18438 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18439 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18441 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18442 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18443 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18444 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18445 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18446 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18447 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18448 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18449 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18451 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18452 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18453 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18454 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18455 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
18457 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
18458 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
18459 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
18460 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
18461 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
18462 disable the undownload faces by customizing
18463 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
18464 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second,
18465 if you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
18466 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to @code{t}.
18467 This parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an
18468 Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
18469 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18471 @node Agent as Cache
18472 @subsection Agent as Cache
18474 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18475 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18476 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18477 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18478 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18479 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18480 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18481 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18482 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18484 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18485 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18486 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18487 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18488 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18491 @subsection Agent Expiry
18493 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18494 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18495 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18496 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18497 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18498 @cindex agent expiry
18499 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18502 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18503 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18504 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18505 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18506 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18507 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18508 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18509 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18511 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
18512 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
18513 synchronized with the group.
18515 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18516 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18518 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18519 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18520 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18521 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18522 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18523 be kept indefinitely.
18525 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18526 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18527 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18528 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18530 @node Agent Regeneration
18531 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18533 @cindex agent regeneration
18534 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18535 @cindex regeneration
18537 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18538 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18539 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18540 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18541 internal inconsistencies.
18543 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18544 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18545 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18546 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18547 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18548 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18550 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18551 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18552 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18553 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18554 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18555 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18557 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18558 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18559 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18560 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18561 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18562 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18565 @node Agent and IMAP
18566 @subsection Agent and IMAP
18568 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
18569 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
18570 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
18571 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
18573 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
18574 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
18575 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
18576 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
18578 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
18579 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
18580 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
18581 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18583 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18584 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18585 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18586 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18587 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18588 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18590 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18591 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18592 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
18593 in the group buffer.
18595 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
18596 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
18601 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
18604 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
18608 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
18609 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
18610 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
18611 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
18612 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
18613 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
18614 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
18615 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
18618 @node Outgoing Messages
18619 @subsection Outgoing Messages
18621 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
18622 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
18623 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
18625 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
18626 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
18627 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
18628 messages in the draft group.
18632 @node Agent Variables
18633 @subsection Agent Variables
18636 @item gnus-agent-directory
18637 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
18638 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
18639 @file{~/News/agent/}.
18641 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
18642 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
18643 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
18644 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
18645 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
18648 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18649 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18650 Hook run when connecting to the network.
18652 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18653 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18654 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
18656 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18657 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18658 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
18660 @item gnus-agent-cache
18661 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
18662 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
18663 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
18664 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
18666 @item gnus-agent-go-online
18667 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
18668 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
18669 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
18670 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
18671 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
18672 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
18675 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18676 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18677 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
18678 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
18679 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
18680 read. The default is @code{t}.
18682 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18683 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18684 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
18685 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
18686 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
18687 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
18688 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
18689 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
18690 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
18691 over and over again.
18693 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18694 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18695 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
18696 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
18697 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
18698 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
18699 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
18700 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
18701 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
18702 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
18703 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
18704 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
18707 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
18708 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
18709 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
18710 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
18711 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
18712 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
18713 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
18714 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
18715 is only valid if the Agent is used.
18717 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18718 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18719 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
18720 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
18721 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
18722 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
18724 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
18725 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
18726 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
18727 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
18728 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
18730 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18731 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18732 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
18733 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
18734 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
18735 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
18736 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
18737 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
18738 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
18739 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
18740 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
18745 @node Example Setup
18746 @subsection Example Setup
18748 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
18749 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
18750 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
18753 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
18754 ;;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
18755 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
18757 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
18758 ;;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
18759 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
18761 ;;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
18762 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
18764 ;;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
18765 ;;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
18766 ;;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
18769 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
18770 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
18773 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
18774 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
18775 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
18776 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
18777 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
18780 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
18781 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
18782 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
18783 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
18784 back all the killed groups.)
18786 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
18787 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
18788 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
18791 @node Batching Agents
18792 @subsection Batching Agents
18793 @findex gnus-agent-batch
18795 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
18796 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
18797 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
18799 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
18800 following incantation:
18804 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
18808 @node Agent Caveats
18809 @subsection Agent Caveats
18811 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
18812 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
18816 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
18818 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
18819 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
18820 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
18822 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
18823 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
18825 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
18829 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
18830 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
18831 locally stored articles.
18838 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
18839 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
18840 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
18843 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
18844 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
18845 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
18846 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
18847 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
18849 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
18850 before generating the summary buffer.
18852 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
18853 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
18854 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
18856 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
18857 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
18858 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
18859 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
18862 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
18863 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
18864 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
18865 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
18866 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
18867 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
18868 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
18869 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
18870 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
18871 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
18872 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
18873 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
18874 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
18875 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
18876 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
18877 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
18878 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
18882 @node Summary Score Commands
18883 @section Summary Score Commands
18884 @cindex score commands
18886 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
18887 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
18888 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
18889 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
18890 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
18892 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
18893 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
18894 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
18895 score file the current one.
18897 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
18902 @kindex V s (Summary)
18903 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
18904 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
18907 @kindex V S (Summary)
18908 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
18909 Display the score of the current article
18910 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
18913 @kindex V t (Summary)
18914 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
18915 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
18916 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
18917 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
18918 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
18919 score file and edit it.
18922 @kindex V w (Summary)
18923 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
18924 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
18927 @kindex V R (Summary)
18928 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
18929 Run the current summary through the scoring process
18930 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
18931 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
18932 effect you're having.
18935 @kindex V c (Summary)
18936 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
18937 Make a different score file the current
18938 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
18941 @kindex V e (Summary)
18942 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
18943 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
18944 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
18948 @kindex V f (Summary)
18949 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
18950 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
18951 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
18954 @kindex V F (Summary)
18955 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
18956 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
18957 after editing score files.
18960 @kindex V C (Summary)
18961 @findex gnus-score-customize
18962 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
18963 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
18967 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
18972 @kindex V m (Summary)
18973 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
18974 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
18975 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
18978 @kindex V x (Summary)
18979 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
18980 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
18981 expunge all articles below this score
18982 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
18985 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
18986 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
18989 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
18990 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
18994 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
18995 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
18997 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
18998 keys are available:
19002 Score on the author name.
19005 Score on the subject line.
19008 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19011 Score on the @code{References} line.
19017 Score on the number of lines.
19020 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19023 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19024 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19027 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19028 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19029 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19038 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19044 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19045 what headers you are scoring on.
19057 Substring matching.
19060 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19089 Greater than number.
19094 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19095 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19096 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19101 Temporary score entry.
19104 Permanent score entry.
19107 Immediately scoring.
19111 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19112 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19113 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19117 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19118 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19119 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19120 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19122 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19123 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19124 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19125 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19126 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19128 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19129 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19130 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19131 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19132 current score file.
19134 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19135 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19136 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19139 @node Group Score Commands
19140 @section Group Score Commands
19141 @cindex group score commands
19143 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19148 @kindex W f (Group)
19149 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19150 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19151 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19152 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19156 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19158 @findex gnus-batch-score
19159 @cindex batch scoring
19161 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19165 @node Score Variables
19166 @section Score Variables
19167 @cindex score variables
19171 @item gnus-use-scoring
19172 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19173 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19174 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19176 @item gnus-kill-killed
19177 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19178 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19179 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19180 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19181 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19182 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19183 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19185 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19186 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19187 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19188 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19189 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19191 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19192 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19193 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19194 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19196 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19197 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19198 @cindex score cache
19199 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19200 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19201 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19202 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19203 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19204 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19205 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19208 @item gnus-save-score
19209 @vindex gnus-save-score
19210 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19211 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19212 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19214 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19215 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19216 across group visits.
19218 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19219 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19220 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19221 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19222 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19223 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19224 manually entered data.
19226 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19227 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19228 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19230 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19231 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19232 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19233 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19234 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19235 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19237 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19238 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19239 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19240 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19242 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19243 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19244 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19245 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19247 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19248 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19249 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19250 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19252 Predefined functions available are:
19255 @item gnus-score-find-single
19256 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19257 Only apply the group's own score file.
19259 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19260 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19261 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19262 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19263 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19264 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19265 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19266 then a regexp match is done.
19268 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19269 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19271 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19272 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19273 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19274 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19276 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19277 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19278 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19279 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19280 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19284 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19285 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19286 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19287 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19288 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19289 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19290 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19293 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19294 overall score file, you could use the value
19296 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19297 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19300 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19301 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19302 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19303 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19304 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19306 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19307 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19308 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19309 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19310 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19311 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19312 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19313 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19315 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19316 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19317 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19319 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19320 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19321 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19322 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19323 threading---according to the current value of
19324 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19325 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19326 simplified in this manner.
19331 @node Score File Format
19332 @section Score File Format
19333 @cindex score file format
19335 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19336 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19337 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19339 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19343 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19345 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19347 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19349 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19354 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19358 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19359 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19360 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19361 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19365 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19366 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19368 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19369 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19370 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19372 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19377 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19378 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19379 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19380 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19381 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19382 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19383 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19384 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19385 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19386 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19387 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19388 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19389 to articles that matches these score entries.
19391 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19392 score entry has one to four elements.
19396 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19397 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19401 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19402 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19403 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19404 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19405 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19406 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19409 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19410 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19411 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19412 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19413 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19416 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19417 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19418 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19419 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19422 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19423 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19424 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19425 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19426 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19427 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19428 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19429 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19430 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19431 instead, if you feel like.
19434 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19435 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19436 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19437 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19438 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19439 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19443 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19444 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19448 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19449 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19451 These predicates are true if
19454 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19457 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19458 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19465 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19466 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19467 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19468 it's not. I think.)
19470 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19471 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19472 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19473 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19476 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19477 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19478 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19479 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19480 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19481 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19482 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19486 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19487 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19488 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19489 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19490 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19491 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19492 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19493 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19496 @item Head, Body, All
19497 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19501 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19502 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19503 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19504 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19505 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19506 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19507 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19511 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19512 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19513 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19514 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19515 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19516 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19517 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19518 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19519 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19520 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19521 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19525 @cindex score file atoms
19527 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19528 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19531 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19532 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19534 @item mark-and-expunge
19535 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19536 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19539 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19540 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
19541 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
19542 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
19543 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
19546 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
19547 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
19550 @item exclude-files
19551 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
19552 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
19556 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
19557 ignored when handling global score files.
19560 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
19561 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
19562 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
19563 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
19566 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
19567 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
19568 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
19569 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
19571 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
19575 (mark-and-expunge -100)
19578 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
19579 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
19580 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
19581 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
19582 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
19584 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
19585 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
19586 scoring rules exist.
19589 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
19590 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
19591 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
19592 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
19593 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
19594 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
19595 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19596 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
19597 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
19598 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
19599 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
19603 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
19604 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
19605 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
19606 file for a number of groups.
19609 @cindex local variables
19610 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
19611 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
19612 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
19613 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
19614 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
19619 @node Score File Editing
19620 @section Score File Editing
19622 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
19623 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
19624 with a mode for that.
19626 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
19627 additional commands:
19632 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
19633 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
19634 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
19635 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
19638 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
19639 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
19640 Insert the current date in numerical format
19641 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
19642 you were wondering.
19645 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
19646 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
19647 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
19648 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
19649 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
19654 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
19656 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
19657 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
19659 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
19660 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
19663 @node Adaptive Scoring
19664 @section Adaptive Scoring
19665 @cindex adaptive scoring
19667 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
19668 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
19669 stupidity, to be precise.
19671 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
19672 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
19673 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
19674 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
19675 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19676 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
19677 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
19678 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
19679 variable to @code{(word line)}.
19681 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19682 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
19683 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
19684 might look something like this:
19687 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19688 '((gnus-unread-mark)
19689 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
19690 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
19691 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
19692 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
19693 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
19694 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
19695 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
19696 (gnus-ancient-mark)
19697 (gnus-low-score-mark)
19698 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
19701 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
19702 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
19703 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
19704 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
19705 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
19706 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
19709 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
19710 will be applied to each article.
19712 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
19713 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
19714 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
19715 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
19717 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
19718 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
19719 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
19720 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
19722 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
19723 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
19724 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
19725 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
19727 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
19728 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
19729 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
19730 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
19731 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
19732 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
19734 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
19735 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
19736 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
19738 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
19739 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
19740 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
19742 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
19743 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
19744 let you use different rules in different groups.
19746 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
19747 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
19748 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
19751 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
19752 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
19753 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
19754 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
19755 the length of the match is less than
19756 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
19757 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
19760 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19761 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
19762 headers. If you adapt on words, the
19763 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
19764 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
19767 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19768 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
19769 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
19770 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
19771 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
19774 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
19775 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
19776 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
19777 score with 30 points.
19779 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
19780 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
19781 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
19782 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
19783 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
19785 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
19786 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
19787 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
19788 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
19789 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
19791 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
19792 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
19793 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
19794 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
19796 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
19797 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
19798 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
19799 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
19801 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
19802 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
19803 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
19804 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
19805 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
19807 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
19808 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
19809 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
19811 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
19812 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
19813 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
19814 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
19817 @node Home Score File
19818 @section Home Score File
19820 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
19821 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
19822 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
19823 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
19825 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
19826 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
19827 could perhaps use the same home score file.
19829 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
19830 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
19835 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
19839 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
19840 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
19844 A list. The elements in this list can be:
19848 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
19849 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
19852 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
19853 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
19854 name of the group as the parameter.
19857 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
19860 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
19865 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
19868 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19869 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
19872 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
19873 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
19875 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
19877 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19878 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
19881 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
19882 Other functions include
19885 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
19886 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
19887 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
19888 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
19892 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
19893 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
19894 their own home score files:
19897 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19898 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
19899 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
19900 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
19901 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
19904 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
19905 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
19906 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
19907 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
19908 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
19910 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
19911 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
19912 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
19913 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
19914 precedence over this variable.
19917 @node Followups To Yourself
19918 @section Followups To Yourself
19920 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
19921 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
19922 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
19923 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
19924 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
19925 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
19929 @item gnus-score-followup-article
19930 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
19931 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
19934 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
19935 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
19936 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
19940 @vindex message-sent-hook
19941 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
19942 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
19944 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
19948 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
19949 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
19953 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19954 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19957 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
19958 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
19963 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
19967 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
19968 is system-dependent.
19971 @node Scoring On Other Headers
19972 @section Scoring On Other Headers
19973 @cindex scoring on other headers
19975 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
19976 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
19977 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
19978 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
19979 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
19981 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
19982 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
19983 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
19984 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
19985 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
19987 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
19990 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
19991 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
19994 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
19995 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
19996 time if you have much mail.
19998 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
19999 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20005 @section Scoring Tips
20006 @cindex scoring tips
20012 @cindex scoring crossposts
20013 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20014 the @code{Xref} header.
20016 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20019 @item Multiple crossposts
20020 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20021 more than, say, 3 groups:
20024 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20028 @item Matching on the body
20029 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20030 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20031 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20032 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20033 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20034 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20035 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20038 @item Marking as read
20039 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20040 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20041 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20045 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20047 @item Negated character classes
20048 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20049 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20050 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20054 @node Reverse Scoring
20055 @section Reverse Scoring
20056 @cindex reverse scoring
20058 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20059 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20060 like this in your score file:
20064 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20069 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20070 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20073 @node Global Score Files
20074 @section Global Score Files
20075 @cindex global score files
20077 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20078 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20079 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20081 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20082 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20083 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20085 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20086 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20087 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20088 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20089 files are applicable to which group.
20091 To use the score file
20092 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20093 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20097 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20098 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20099 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20102 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20104 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20105 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20106 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20107 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20109 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20110 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20112 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20113 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20114 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20115 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20116 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20117 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20119 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20125 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20127 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20129 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20131 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20132 lowered out of existence.
20134 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20135 articles completely.
20138 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20139 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20140 old articles for a long time.
20143 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20144 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20145 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20146 holding our breath yet?
20150 @section Kill Files
20153 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20154 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20155 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20157 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20158 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20159 files into score files.
20161 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20162 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20163 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20164 that isn't a very good idea.
20166 Normal kill files look like this:
20169 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20170 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20174 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20175 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20177 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20178 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20181 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20186 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20187 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20188 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20191 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20192 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20193 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20196 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20201 @kindex M-k (Group)
20202 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20203 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20206 @kindex M-K (Group)
20207 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20208 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20211 Kill file variables:
20214 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20215 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20216 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20217 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20218 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20219 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20220 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20222 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20223 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20224 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20225 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20228 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20229 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20230 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20231 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20232 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20233 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20234 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20235 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20236 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20238 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20239 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20240 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20245 @node Converting Kill Files
20246 @section Converting Kill Files
20248 @cindex converting kill files
20250 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20251 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20252 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20255 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20256 You can fetch it from
20257 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20259 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20260 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20261 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20269 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20270 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20272 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20273 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20274 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20275 news articles generated every day.
20277 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20278 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20279 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20280 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20281 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20282 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20283 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20284 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20288 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20289 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20290 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20291 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20295 @node Using GroupLens
20296 @subsection Using GroupLens
20298 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20299 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20300 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20302 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20306 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20307 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20308 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20309 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20311 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20312 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20313 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20314 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20316 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20317 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20318 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20322 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20323 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20324 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20325 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20326 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20327 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20330 @node Rating Articles
20331 @subsection Rating Articles
20333 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20334 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20335 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20336 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20339 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
20344 @kindex r (GroupLens)
20345 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
20346 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
20349 @kindex k (GroupLens)
20350 @findex grouplens-score-thread
20351 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
20352 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
20353 threads in rec.humor.
20357 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
20358 the score of the article you're reading.
20363 @kindex n (GroupLens)
20364 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
20365 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
20368 @kindex , (GroupLens)
20369 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
20370 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
20374 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
20375 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
20378 @node Displaying Predictions
20379 @subsection Displaying Predictions
20381 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
20382 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
20383 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
20384 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
20385 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
20387 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
20388 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
20389 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
20390 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
20391 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
20392 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
20393 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
20394 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
20395 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
20396 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
20397 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
20398 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
20399 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
20401 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
20402 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
20403 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
20404 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
20406 The following are valid values for that variable.
20409 @item prediction-spot
20410 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
20413 @item confidence-interval
20414 A numeric confidence interval.
20416 @item prediction-bar
20417 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
20419 @item confidence-bar
20420 Numerical confidence.
20422 @item confidence-spot
20423 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
20425 @item prediction-num
20426 Plain-old numeric value.
20428 @item confidence-plus-minus
20429 Prediction +/- confidence.
20434 @node GroupLens Variables
20435 @subsection GroupLens Variables
20439 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
20440 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
20441 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
20442 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
20445 @item grouplens-bbb-host
20446 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
20449 @item grouplens-bbb-port
20450 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
20452 @item grouplens-score-offset
20453 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
20454 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
20457 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
20458 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
20459 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
20464 @node Advanced Scoring
20465 @section Advanced Scoring
20467 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20468 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20469 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20470 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20471 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20473 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20477 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20478 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20479 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20483 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20484 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20486 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20487 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20488 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20489 non-@code{nil} value.
20491 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20492 operator, and various match operators.
20499 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20500 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20501 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20506 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20507 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20508 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20513 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20514 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20518 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20519 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20520 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20521 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20522 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20523 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20524 the ancestry you want to go.
20526 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20527 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20528 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20529 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20530 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20533 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20534 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20536 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20537 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20540 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20541 when he's talking about Gnus:
20546 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20547 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20554 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20558 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20565 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20566 really don't want to read what he's written:
20570 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20571 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
20575 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20576 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20577 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20584 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20585 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20586 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20587 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20591 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20592 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20593 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20594 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20597 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20599 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20603 The possibilities are endless.
20605 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20606 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20608 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20609 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20610 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20611 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20612 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20613 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20614 @samp{subject}) first.
20616 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20617 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20628 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20629 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20635 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20642 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20643 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20648 @section Score Decays
20649 @cindex score decays
20652 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20653 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20654 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20655 use them in any sensible way.
20657 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20658 @findex gnus-decay-score
20659 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20660 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20661 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20662 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20663 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20664 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
20665 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
20666 definition of that function:
20669 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20670 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20671 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20673 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20675 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20677 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20678 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20679 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
20680 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20681 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20683 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20687 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20688 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20689 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20690 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20694 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20697 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20700 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20704 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20705 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20706 the new score, which should be an integer.
20708 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20709 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20714 @include message.texi
20715 @chapter Emacs MIME
20716 @include emacs-mime.texi
20718 @include sieve.texi
20728 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
20729 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
20730 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
20731 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
20732 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
20733 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
20734 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
20735 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
20736 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
20737 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
20738 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
20739 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
20740 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
20741 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
20742 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
20743 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
20744 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
20745 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
20746 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
20747 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
20748 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
20752 @node Process/Prefix
20753 @section Process/Prefix
20754 @cindex process/prefix convention
20756 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
20757 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
20759 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
20760 command to be performed on.
20764 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
20765 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
20766 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
20767 with the current one.
20769 @vindex transient-mark-mode
20770 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
20771 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
20773 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
20774 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
20777 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
20778 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
20780 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
20783 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
20784 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
20785 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
20786 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
20788 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
20789 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
20790 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
20791 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
20792 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
20793 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
20794 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
20795 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
20797 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
20798 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
20799 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
20800 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
20801 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
20805 @section Interactive
20806 @cindex interaction
20810 @item gnus-novice-user
20811 @vindex gnus-novice-user
20812 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
20813 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
20814 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
20815 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
20818 @item gnus-expert-user
20819 @vindex gnus-expert-user
20820 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
20821 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
20822 matter how strange.
20824 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
20825 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
20826 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
20827 is @code{t} by default.
20829 @item gnus-interactive-exit
20830 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
20831 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20836 @node Symbolic Prefixes
20837 @section Symbolic Prefixes
20838 @cindex symbolic prefixes
20840 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
20841 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
20842 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
20843 rule of 900 to the current article.
20845 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
20846 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
20847 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
20848 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
20849 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
20850 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
20851 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
20853 @kindex M-i (Summary)
20854 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
20855 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
20856 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
20857 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
20858 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
20859 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
20860 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
20861 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
20863 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
20864 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
20865 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
20867 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
20871 @node Formatting Variables
20872 @section Formatting Variables
20873 @cindex formatting variables
20875 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
20876 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
20877 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
20878 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
20879 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
20882 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
20883 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
20884 lots of percentages everywhere.
20887 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
20888 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
20889 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
20890 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
20891 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
20892 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
20893 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
20894 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
20897 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
20898 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
20899 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
20900 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
20901 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
20902 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
20903 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
20904 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
20906 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
20907 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
20909 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
20910 @findex gnus-update-format
20911 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
20912 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
20913 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
20914 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
20918 @node Formatting Basics
20919 @subsection Formatting Basics
20921 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
20922 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
20923 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
20925 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
20926 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
20927 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
20928 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
20929 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
20932 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
20933 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
20934 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
20935 less than 4 characters wide.
20937 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
20938 @samp{%&user-date;}.
20941 @node Mode Line Formatting
20942 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
20944 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
20945 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
20946 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
20947 with the following two differences:
20952 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
20955 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
20956 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
20957 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
20958 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
20959 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
20960 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
20961 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
20966 @node Advanced Formatting
20967 @subsection Advanced Formatting
20969 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
20970 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
20971 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
20972 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
20974 These are the valid modifiers:
20979 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
20983 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
20988 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
20991 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
20996 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
20999 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
21002 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
21005 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
21011 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
21016 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
21017 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
21018 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
21019 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
21020 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
21021 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
21022 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
21024 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
21025 last operation, padding.
21027 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
21028 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
21029 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
21030 @xref{Compilation}.
21033 @node User-Defined Specs
21034 @subsection User-Defined Specs
21036 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
21037 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
21038 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
21039 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
21040 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
21041 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
21042 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
21043 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
21044 should protect against that.
21046 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
21047 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
21049 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
21050 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
21051 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
21052 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
21056 @node Formatting Fonts
21057 @subsection Formatting Fonts
21059 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
21060 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
21061 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
21062 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
21065 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
21066 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
21067 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
21068 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
21069 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
21070 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
21072 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
21073 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
21074 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
21075 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
21076 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
21077 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
21078 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
21079 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
21080 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
21081 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
21082 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
21085 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
21088 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
21089 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
21090 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
21092 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
21093 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
21094 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
21095 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
21096 ;; @r{Set the color.}
21097 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
21098 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
21100 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
21101 (setq gnus-group-line-format
21102 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
21105 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
21106 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
21108 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
21109 mode-line variables.
21111 @node Positioning Point
21112 @subsection Positioning Point
21114 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
21115 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
21116 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
21118 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
21120 @findex gnus-goto-colon
21121 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
21122 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
21124 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
21125 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
21126 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
21131 @subsection Tabulation
21133 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
21134 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
21135 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
21136 about lining up the following text afterwards.
21138 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21139 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21141 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21142 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21143 This is the soft tabulator.
21145 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21146 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21147 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21150 @node Wide Characters
21151 @subsection Wide Characters
21153 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21154 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21155 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21157 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21158 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21159 these countries, that's not true.
21161 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21162 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21163 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21164 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21168 @node Window Layout
21169 @section Window Layout
21170 @cindex window layout
21172 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21174 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21175 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21176 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21177 @code{t} by default.
21179 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21180 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21182 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21183 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21184 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21187 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21188 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21189 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21193 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21194 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21195 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21196 possible names is listed below.
21198 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21199 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21202 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21206 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21207 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21208 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21209 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21210 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21211 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21212 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21213 size spec per split.
21215 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21216 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21217 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21218 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21219 present) gets focus.
21221 Here's a more complicated example:
21224 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21225 (summary 0.25 point)
21226 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21230 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21231 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21232 occupy, not a percentage.
21234 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21235 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21236 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21237 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21238 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21241 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21244 (article (horizontal 1.0
21249 (summary 0.25 point)
21254 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21255 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21257 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21258 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21259 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21260 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21261 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21263 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21264 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21265 lines from the splits.
21267 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21272 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21273 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21274 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21275 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21276 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21277 size = number | frame-params
21278 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21282 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21283 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21284 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21285 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21287 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21288 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21289 @cindex window height
21290 @cindex window width
21291 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21292 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21293 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21294 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21295 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21296 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21298 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21299 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21300 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21301 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21303 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21304 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21305 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21306 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21307 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21308 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21309 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21310 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21311 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21312 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21313 configuration list.
21316 (gnus-configure-frame
21320 (article 0.3 point))
21328 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21329 @code{frame} split:
21332 (gnus-configure-frame
21335 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21337 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21338 (user-position . t)
21339 (left . -1) (top . 1))
21344 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
21345 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
21346 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
21347 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
21348 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
21349 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
21350 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
21351 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
21353 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
21354 be found in its default value.
21356 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
21357 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
21358 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
21362 (message (horizontal 1.0
21363 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
21365 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
21370 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
21371 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
21372 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
21377 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
21378 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
21379 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
21380 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
21381 (name . "Message"))
21382 (message 1.0 point))))
21385 @findex gnus-add-configuration
21386 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
21387 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
21388 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
21389 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
21392 (gnus-add-configuration
21393 '(article (vertical 1.0
21395 (summary .25 point)
21399 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
21400 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
21401 Gnus has been loaded.
21403 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
21404 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
21405 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
21406 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
21407 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
21409 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
21410 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
21411 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
21414 @subsection Example Window Configurations
21418 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
21419 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
21434 (gnus-add-configuration
21437 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21439 (summary 0.16 point)
21442 (gnus-add-configuration
21445 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21446 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
21452 @node Faces and Fonts
21453 @section Faces and Fonts
21458 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
21459 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
21460 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
21465 @section Compilation
21466 @cindex compilation
21467 @cindex byte-compilation
21469 @findex gnus-compile
21471 Remember all those line format specification variables?
21472 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
21473 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
21474 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
21475 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
21476 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
21479 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
21480 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
21481 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
21482 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
21483 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
21484 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
21485 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
21489 @section Mode Lines
21492 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
21493 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
21494 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
21495 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
21496 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
21497 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
21498 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
21501 @cindex display-time
21503 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
21504 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
21505 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
21506 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
21507 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
21508 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
21509 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
21510 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
21513 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
21515 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
21516 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
21518 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
21519 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
21520 (length display-time-string)))))
21523 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
21524 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
21525 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
21526 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
21527 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
21530 @node Highlighting and Menus
21531 @section Highlighting and Menus
21533 @cindex highlighting
21536 @vindex gnus-visual
21537 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
21538 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
21539 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
21542 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
21543 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
21546 @item group-highlight
21547 Do highlights in the group buffer.
21548 @item summary-highlight
21549 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
21550 @item article-highlight
21551 Do highlights in the article buffer.
21553 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
21555 Create menus in the group buffer.
21557 Create menus in the summary buffers.
21559 Create menus in the article buffer.
21561 Create menus in the browse buffer.
21563 Create menus in the server buffer.
21565 Create menus in the score buffers.
21567 Create menus in all buffers.
21570 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
21571 buffers, you could say something like:
21574 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
21577 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
21580 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
21583 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
21584 in all Gnus buffers.
21586 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
21589 @item gnus-mouse-face
21590 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21591 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
21592 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
21596 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
21600 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
21601 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
21602 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
21604 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
21605 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
21606 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
21608 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
21609 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
21610 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
21612 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
21613 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
21614 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
21616 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
21617 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
21618 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
21620 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
21621 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
21622 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
21633 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
21634 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
21635 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
21636 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
21637 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
21641 @vindex gnus-carpal
21642 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
21643 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
21644 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
21649 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21650 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21651 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
21653 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
21654 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
21655 Face used on buttons.
21657 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
21658 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
21659 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
21661 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21662 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21663 Buttons in the group buffer.
21665 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21666 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21667 Buttons in the summary buffer.
21669 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21670 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21671 Buttons in the server buffer.
21673 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21674 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21675 Buttons in the browse buffer.
21678 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
21679 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
21680 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
21688 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
21689 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
21690 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
21691 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
21692 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
21694 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
21695 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
21696 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
21698 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
21699 been idle for thirty minutes:
21702 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
21705 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
21709 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
21712 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
21713 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
21714 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21716 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
21717 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
21718 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
21719 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21721 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
21722 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
21723 @var{idle} minutes.
21725 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
21726 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
21729 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
21730 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
21731 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
21733 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
21734 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
21735 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
21736 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
21738 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
21739 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21741 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
21743 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
21746 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
21747 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
21748 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
21749 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
21750 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
21751 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
21752 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
21753 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
21754 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
21755 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
21756 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
21758 @findex gnus-demon-init
21759 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
21760 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
21761 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
21762 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
21763 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
21765 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
21766 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
21767 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
21776 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
21777 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
21779 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
21780 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
21781 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
21782 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
21785 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
21786 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
21787 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
21788 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
21790 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
21791 this will make spam disappear.
21793 There are some variables to customize, of course:
21796 @item gnus-use-nocem
21797 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
21798 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
21801 You can also set this variable to a positive number as a group level.
21802 In that case, Gnus scans NoCeM messages when checking new news if this
21803 value is not exceeding a group level that you specify as the prefix
21804 argument to some commands, e.g. @code{gnus},
21805 @code{gnus-group-get-new-news}, etc. Otherwise, Gnus does not scan
21806 NoCeM messages if you specify a group level to those commands. For
21807 example, if you use 1 or 2 on the mail groups and the levels on the news
21808 groups remain the default, 3 is the best choice.
21810 @item gnus-nocem-groups
21811 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
21812 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
21815 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
21816 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
21819 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
21820 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
21821 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
21822 people you want to listen to. The default is
21824 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
21825 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
21827 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
21829 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
21830 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
21832 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
21833 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
21834 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
21835 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
21836 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
21837 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
21838 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
21839 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
21840 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
21841 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
21843 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
21844 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
21847 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
21850 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
21851 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
21854 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
21857 The specs are applied left-to-right.
21860 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
21861 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
21863 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
21864 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
21865 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
21866 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
21867 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
21868 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
21870 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
21871 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
21872 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
21873 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
21875 @item gnus-nocem-directory
21876 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
21877 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
21878 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
21880 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21881 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21882 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
21883 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
21884 might then see old spam.
21886 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
21887 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
21888 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
21889 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
21890 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
21893 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21894 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21895 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
21896 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
21900 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
21901 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
21902 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
21903 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
21910 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
21911 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
21912 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
21914 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
21915 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
21916 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
21917 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
21918 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
21919 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
21920 @code{undo} function.
21922 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
21923 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
21924 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
21925 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
21926 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
21927 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
21928 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
21929 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
21930 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
21931 never be totally undoable.
21933 @findex gnus-undo-mode
21934 @vindex gnus-use-undo
21936 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
21937 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
21938 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
21939 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
21943 @node Predicate Specifiers
21944 @section Predicate Specifiers
21945 @cindex predicate specifiers
21947 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
21948 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
21949 to type all that much.
21951 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
21956 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
21957 gnus-article-unread-p)
21960 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
21961 functions all take one parameter.
21963 @findex gnus-make-predicate
21964 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
21965 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
21966 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
21971 @section Moderation
21974 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
21975 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
21976 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
21979 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
21983 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
21986 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
21988 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
21993 You split your incoming mail by matching on
21994 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
21995 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
21998 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
21999 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
22002 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
22003 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
22007 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
22010 (setq gnus-moderated-list
22011 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
22015 @node Fetching a Group
22016 @section Fetching a Group
22017 @cindex fetching a group
22019 @findex gnus-fetch-group
22020 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
22021 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
22022 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
22023 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
22024 It takes the group name as a parameter.
22027 @node Image Enhancements
22028 @section Image Enhancements
22030 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
22031 support images yet.}, is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has
22032 taken advantage of that.
22035 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
22036 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
22037 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
22038 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
22039 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
22047 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
22048 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
22049 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
22053 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
22054 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
22055 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
22063 Decoding an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
22064 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
22065 have @samp{compface} installed on your system. If either is true,
22066 Gnus will default to displaying @code{X-Face} headers.
22068 The variable that controls this is the
22069 @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable. If this variable is a
22070 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
22071 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
22072 If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches
22073 the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
22075 The default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
22076 @code{display} program@footnote{@code{display} is from the ImageMagick
22077 package. For the @code{uncompface} and @code{icontopbm} programs look
22078 for a package like @code{compface} or @code{faces-xface} on a GNU/Linux
22079 system.} to view the face.
22081 Under XEmacs or Emacs 21+ with suitable image support, the default
22082 action is to display the face before the @code{From} header. (It's
22083 nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support---that
22084 will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native @code{X-Face}
22085 support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
22086 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and
22087 friends.@footnote{On a GNU/Linux system look for packages with names
22088 like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.})
22090 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
22098 @vindex gnus-x-face
22099 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
22100 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
22101 default colors are black and white.
22104 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
22105 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
22106 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
22107 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages.
22109 @findex gnus-random-x-face
22110 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
22111 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
22112 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
22113 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
22114 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
22115 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
22116 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
22117 header data as a string.
22119 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
22120 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
22121 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
22122 randomly generated data.
22124 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
22125 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
22126 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
22127 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
22128 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
22130 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
22131 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22134 (setq message-required-news-headers
22135 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22136 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
22139 Using the last function would be something like this:
22142 (setq message-required-news-headers
22143 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22144 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22145 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22146 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22154 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces'implementations should really be harmonized.
22156 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22157 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22158 represent the author of the message.
22161 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22162 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22163 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22166 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22167 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22169 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22170 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22171 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22173 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22174 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22175 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22176 converts the file to Face format by using the
22177 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22179 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22180 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22183 (setq message-required-news-headers
22184 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22185 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22186 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22191 @subsection Smileys
22196 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22201 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22202 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22204 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22205 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22208 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22211 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22212 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22213 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22214 text and maps that to file names.
22216 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22217 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22218 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22219 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22220 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22223 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22228 @item smiley-data-directory
22229 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22230 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22232 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22233 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22234 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22248 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22249 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22250 over your shoulder as you read news.
22252 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22261 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22262 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22263 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22264 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22265 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22266 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22267 @code{GIF} formats.
22270 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22271 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22272 point your Web browser at
22273 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22275 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22276 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22278 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22279 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22282 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22286 @item gnus-picon-databases
22287 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22288 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22289 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22290 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22291 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22293 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22294 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22295 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22296 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22298 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22299 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22300 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22301 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22303 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22304 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22305 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22306 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22307 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22309 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22310 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22311 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22312 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22318 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22321 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22322 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22323 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22324 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22325 unusual directory structure.
22327 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22328 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22329 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
22334 @subsubsection Toolbar
22338 @item gnus-use-toolbar
22339 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
22340 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
22341 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
22342 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
22343 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
22344 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
22345 names show. The default is @code{default}.
22347 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
22348 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
22349 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
22350 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
22351 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
22352 The default is that of the default toolbar.
22354 @item gnus-group-toolbar
22355 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
22356 The toolbar in the group buffer.
22358 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
22359 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
22360 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
22362 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22363 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22364 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
22375 @node Fuzzy Matching
22376 @section Fuzzy Matching
22377 @cindex fuzzy matching
22379 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
22380 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
22382 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
22383 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
22384 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
22386 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
22387 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
22388 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
22389 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
22390 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
22393 @node Thwarting Email Spam
22394 @section Thwarting Email Spam
22398 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22400 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
22401 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
22402 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
22403 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
22404 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
22405 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
22406 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
22407 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
22410 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
22411 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
22412 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
22413 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
22414 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
22415 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
22417 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
22420 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
22421 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
22422 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
22423 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
22424 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
22425 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
22428 @node The problem of spam
22429 @subsection The problem of spam
22431 @cindex spam filtering approaches
22432 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
22434 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22436 First, some background on spam.
22438 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
22439 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
22440 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
22441 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
22442 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
22443 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
22444 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
22445 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
22446 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
22448 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
22449 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
22450 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
22451 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
22452 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
22453 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
22454 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
22455 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
22456 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
22459 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
22460 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
22461 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
22462 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
22463 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
22464 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
22465 from Bulgarian IPs.
22467 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
22468 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
22469 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
22470 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
22472 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
22473 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
22474 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
22475 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
22477 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
22478 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
22479 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
22480 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
22481 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
22482 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
22483 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
22484 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
22485 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
22487 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
22488 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
22489 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
22490 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
22491 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
22492 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
22493 down for some time because of the incident.
22495 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
22496 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
22497 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
22498 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
22499 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
22500 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
22501 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
22502 to store the database of spam analyses. Statistical analysis on the
22503 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
22504 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
22505 the server that it has misclassified mail.
22507 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
22508 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
22509 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
22510 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
22511 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
22512 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
22513 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
22516 @node Anti-Spam Basics
22517 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
22521 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22523 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
22524 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
22526 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
22527 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
22528 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
22529 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
22530 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
22531 part of the mail address.)
22534 (setq message-default-news-headers
22535 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
22538 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
22539 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22543 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
22544 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
22545 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
22550 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
22551 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
22552 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
22553 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
22555 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
22556 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
22557 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
22558 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
22559 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
22560 your fancy split rule in this way:
22565 (to "larsi" "misc")
22569 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
22570 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
22571 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
22572 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
22573 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
22575 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
22576 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
22577 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
22578 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
22580 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
22584 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
22585 @cindex SpamAssassin
22586 @cindex Vipul's Razor
22589 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
22590 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
22591 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
22592 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
22593 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
22594 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
22595 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
22597 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
22598 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
22599 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
22602 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
22603 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
22604 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
22605 Specifiers}) follow.
22609 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
22613 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
22616 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
22617 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
22618 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
22621 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
22625 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22628 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
22629 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
22633 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
22634 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
22635 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
22636 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
22639 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
22641 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
22645 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
22646 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
22650 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
22651 downloaded by default. You need to set
22652 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
22653 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
22655 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
22656 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
22657 spam. And here is the nifty function:
22660 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
22661 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
22663 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
22664 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
22665 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
22669 @subsection Hashcash
22672 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
22673 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
22674 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
22675 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
22676 in smaller communities.
22678 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
22679 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
22680 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
22681 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
22682 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
22683 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
22684 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
22685 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
22686 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
22687 one of them separately.
22690 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
22691 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
22692 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
22693 header. For more details, and for the external application
22694 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
22695 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
22696 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
22698 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
22702 (require 'hashcash)
22703 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
22706 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
22707 contrib directory or at
22708 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
22710 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
22714 @item hashcash-default-payment
22715 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
22716 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
22717 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
22718 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
22720 @item hashcash-payment-alist
22721 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
22722 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
22723 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
22724 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
22725 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
22726 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
22727 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
22728 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
22732 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
22736 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
22737 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
22738 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
22739 a useful contribution, however.
22741 @node Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22742 @subsection Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22743 @cindex spam filtering
22746 The idea behind @file{spam.el} is to have a control center for spam detection
22747 and filtering in Gnus. To that end, @file{spam.el} does two things: it
22748 filters new mail, and it analyzes mail known to be spam or ham.
22749 @dfn{Ham} is the name used throughout @file{spam.el} to indicate
22752 @cindex spam-initialize
22753 First of all, you @strong{must} run the function
22754 @code{spam-initialize} to autoload @code{spam.el} and to install the
22755 @code{spam.el} hooks. There is one exception: if you use the
22756 @code{spam-use-stat} (@pxref{spam-stat spam filtering}) setting, you
22757 should turn it on before @code{spam-initialize}:
22760 (setq spam-use-stat t) ;; if needed
22764 So, what happens when you load @file{spam.el}?
22766 First, some hooks will get installed by @code{spam-initialize}. There
22767 are some hooks for @code{spam-stat} so it can save its databases, and
22768 there are hooks so interesting things will happen when you enter and
22769 leave a group. More on the sequence of events later (@pxref{Spam
22770 ELisp Package Sequence of Events}).
22772 You get the following keyboard commands:
22782 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22783 @code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}.
22785 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark.
22786 Whenever you see a spam article, make sure to mark its summary line
22787 with @kbd{M-d} before leaving the group. This is done automatically
22788 for unread articles in @emph{spam} groups.
22794 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
22795 @code{spam-bogofilter-score}.
22797 You must have Bogofilter installed for that command to work properly.
22803 Also, when you load @file{spam.el}, you will be able to customize its
22804 variables. Try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{spam} variable
22808 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
22809 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
22810 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
22811 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
22812 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
22813 * BBDB Whitelists::
22814 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
22815 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
22817 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
22819 * ifile spam filtering::
22820 * spam-stat spam filtering::
22822 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
22825 @node Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22826 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22827 @cindex spam filtering
22828 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
22831 You must read this section to understand how @code{spam.el} works.
22832 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
22834 There are two @emph{contact points}, if you will, between
22835 @code{spam.el} and the rest of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and
22838 Getting new mail is done in one of two ways. You can either split
22839 your incoming mail or you can classify new articles as ham or spam
22840 when you enter the group.
22842 Splitting incoming mail is better suited to mail backends such as
22843 @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap} where new mail appears in a single file
22844 called a @dfn{Spool File}. See @xref{Spam ELisp Package Filtering of
22847 For backends such as @code{nntp} there is no incoming mail spool, so
22848 an alternate mechanism must be used. This may also happen for
22849 backends where the server is in charge of splitting incoming mail, and
22850 Gnus does not do further splitting. The @code{spam-autodetect} and
22851 @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameters (accessible with
22852 @kbd{G c} and @kbd{G p} as usual), and the corresponding variables
22853 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} and
22854 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} (accessible with @kbd{M-x
22855 customize-variable} as usual).
22857 When @code{spam-autodetect} is used, it hooks into the process of
22858 entering a group. Thus, entering a group with unseen or unread
22859 articles becomes the substitute for checking incoming mail. Whether
22860 only unseen articles or all unread articles will be processed is
22861 determined by the @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages}. When set
22862 to @code{t}, unread messages will be rechecked.
22864 @code{spam-autodetect} grants the user at once more and less control
22865 of spam filtering. The user will have more control over each group's
22866 spam methods, so for instance the @samp{ding} group may have
22867 @code{spam-use-BBDB} as the autodetection method, while the
22868 @samp{suspect} group may have the @code{spam-use-blacklist} and
22869 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods enabled. Every article detected to
22870 be spam will be marked with the spam mark @samp{$} and processed on
22871 exit from the group as normal spam. The user has less control over
22872 the @emph{sequence} of checks, as he might with @code{spam-split}.
22874 When the newly split mail goes into groups, or messages are
22875 autodetected to be ham or spam, those groups must be exited (after
22876 entering, if needed) for further spam processing to happen. It
22877 matters whether the group is considered a ham group, a spam group, or
22878 is unclassified, based on its @code{spam-content} parameter
22879 (@pxref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). Spam groups have the
22880 additional characteristic that, when entered, any unseen or unread
22881 articles (depending on the @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam}
22882 variable) will be marked as spam. Thus, mail split into a spam group
22883 gets automatically marked as spam when you enter the group.
22885 So, when you exit a group, the @code{spam-processors} are applied, if
22886 any are set, and the processed mail is moved to the
22887 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination}
22888 depending on the article's classification. If the
22889 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination},
22890 whichever is appropriate, are @code{nil}, the article is left in the
22893 If a spam is found in any group (this can be changed to only non-spam
22894 groups with @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only}), it is
22895 processed by the active @code{spam-processors} (@pxref{Spam ELisp
22896 Package Global Variables}) when the group is exited. Furthermore, the
22897 spam is moved to the @code{spam-process-destination} (@pxref{Spam
22898 ELisp Package Global Variables}) for further training or deletion.
22899 You have to load the @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22900 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want spam to be processed
22901 no more than once. Thus, spam is detected and processed everywhere,
22902 which is what most people want. If the
22903 @code{spam-process-destination} is @code{nil}, the spam is marked as
22904 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
22906 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22907 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22909 If a ham mail is found in a ham group, as determined by the
22910 @code{ham-marks} parameter, it is processed as ham by the active ham
22911 @code{spam-processor} when the group is exited. With the variables
22912 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
22913 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} the behavior can be further
22914 altered so ham found anywhere can be processed. You have to load the
22915 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22916 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want ham to be processed
22917 no more than once. Thus, ham is detected and processed only when
22918 necessary, which is what most people want. More on this in
22919 @xref{Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples}.
22921 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22922 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22924 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
22925 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
22926 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
22928 @node Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22929 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22930 @cindex spam filtering
22931 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
22934 To use the @file{spam.el} facilities for incoming mail filtering, you
22935 must add the following to your fancy split list
22936 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}:
22942 Note that the fancy split may be called @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
22943 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on whether you use the nnmail or
22944 nnimap back ends to retrieve your mail.
22946 Also, @code{spam-split} will not modify incoming mail in any way.
22948 The @code{spam-split} function will process incoming mail and send the
22949 mail considered to be spam into the group name given by the variable
22950 @code{spam-split-group}. By default that group name is @samp{spam},
22951 but you can customize @code{spam-split-group}. Make sure the contents
22952 of @code{spam-split-group} are an @emph{unqualified} group name, for
22953 instance in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server} the value
22954 @samp{spam} will turn out to be @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The
22955 value @samp{nnimap+server:spam}, therefore, is wrong and will
22956 actually give you the group
22957 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam} which may or may not
22958 work depending on your server's tolerance for strange group names.
22960 You can also give @code{spam-split} a parameter,
22961 e.g. @code{spam-use-regex-headers} or @code{"maybe-spam"}. Why is
22964 Take these split rules (with @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and
22965 @code{spam-use-blackholes} set):
22968 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
22969 (any "ding" "ding")
22971 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22975 Now, the problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the
22976 ding folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam
22977 detected by SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through,
22978 when it's sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to
22979 the ding list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the
22980 invocation of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
22982 You can let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, but all other
22983 @code{spam-split} rules (including a second invocation of the
22984 regex-headers check) will be after the ding rule:
22989 ;; @r{all spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
22990 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
22991 (any "ding" "ding")
22992 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
22994 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22998 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
22999 your particular needs, and to target the results of those checks to a
23000 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
23001 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
23002 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
23003 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
23004 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
23006 You should still have specific checks such as
23007 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} set to @code{t}, even if you
23008 specifically invoke @code{spam-split} with the check. The reason is
23009 that when loading @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done
23010 depending on what @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. This
23011 is usually not critical, though.
23013 @emph{Note for IMAP users}
23015 The boolean variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} needs to be
23016 set, if you want to split based on the whole message instead of just
23017 the headers. By default, the nnimap back end will only retrieve the
23018 message headers. If you use @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
23019 @code{spam-check-ifile}, or @code{spam-check-stat} (the splitters that
23020 can benefit from the full message body), you should set this variable.
23021 It is not set by default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and
23022 that is not an appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user.
23024 @xref{Splitting in IMAP}.
23026 @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
23027 statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
23030 @node Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
23031 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
23032 @cindex spam filtering
23033 @cindex spam filtering variables
23034 @cindex spam variables
23037 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
23038 The concepts of ham processors and spam processors are very important.
23039 Ham processors and spam processors for a group can be set with the
23040 @code{spam-process} group parameter, or the
23041 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. Ham processors take
23042 mail known to be non-spam (@emph{ham}) and process it in some way so
23043 that later similar mail will also be considered non-spam. Spam
23044 processors take mail known to be spam and process it so similar spam
23045 will be detected later.
23047 The format of the spam or ham processor entry used to be a symbol,
23048 but now it is a @sc{cons} cell. See the individual spam processor entries
23049 for more information.
23051 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23052 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
23053 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
23054 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
23055 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
23056 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
23057 by customizing the corresponding variable
23058 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
23059 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
23060 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
23061 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
23062 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
23063 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
23064 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
23067 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
23069 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
23070 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
23071 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
23072 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
23073 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
23074 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
23075 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
23076 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
23077 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
23078 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
23079 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
23080 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
23081 processor which will study them as spam samples.
23083 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
23084 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
23085 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
23086 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
23087 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
23088 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
23089 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
23090 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
23093 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23094 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
23095 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
23096 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
23097 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
23098 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
23099 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
23104 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23105 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
23106 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
23107 you really want to.
23110 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
23111 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
23112 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
23113 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
23114 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
23115 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
23118 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23119 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
23120 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
23121 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
23122 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
23123 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
23124 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
23125 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
23126 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
23127 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
23128 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
23129 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
23130 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
23131 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
23132 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
23134 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23135 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23137 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23138 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23139 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23141 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23142 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23144 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23145 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23146 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23147 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23148 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23150 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23151 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23152 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23153 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23154 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23157 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23158 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23159 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23160 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23161 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23162 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23163 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23164 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23165 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23166 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23167 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23168 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23169 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23171 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23172 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23174 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23175 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23178 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23179 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23180 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23181 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23182 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23183 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23184 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23186 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23187 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23188 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23189 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23191 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23192 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23193 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23194 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23195 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23196 from the mail server.
23198 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23199 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23200 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23201 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23203 @node Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23204 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23205 @cindex spam filtering
23206 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23207 @cindex spam configuration examples
23210 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23212 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23214 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23215 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23216 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23219 ;; @r{I like @kbd{C-s} for marking spam}
23220 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map "\C-s" 'gnus-summary-mark-as-spam)
23223 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23225 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23226 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23227 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23228 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23229 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23230 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23231 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23232 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23233 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23234 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23235 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23236 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23237 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23238 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23239 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23240 (any "ding" "ding")
23241 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23243 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23246 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23248 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23249 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23250 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23251 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23253 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23255 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23256 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23257 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23258 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23259 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23261 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23262 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23264 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23266 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23267 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23269 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23270 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23271 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23273 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23275 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23276 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23278 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23279 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23280 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23282 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23283 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23284 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23285 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23287 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23288 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23289 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23293 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23294 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23296 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23297 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23298 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23299 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23300 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23301 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23302 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23303 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23304 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23306 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23307 does most of the job for me:
23310 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23311 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23312 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23313 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23314 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23315 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23316 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23321 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23323 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23324 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23325 bogofilter or DCC).
23327 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23328 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23329 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark (@code{ham-marks},
23330 @ref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). On group exit, those
23331 messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want to have
23332 the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter) and
23333 deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23335 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23336 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23337 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23338 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23339 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23340 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23342 @item @b{Ham folders:}
23344 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
23345 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
23346 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
23347 @samp{training.ham}.
23350 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
23352 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23354 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
23355 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
23356 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
23360 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
23363 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
23364 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
23365 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
23366 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
23367 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
23369 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
23370 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
23371 @cindex spam filtering
23372 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
23373 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
23376 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
23378 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
23379 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
23380 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
23381 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
23386 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
23388 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
23389 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
23390 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23391 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
23392 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23396 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
23398 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
23399 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23400 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
23404 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
23406 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23407 customizing the group parameters or the
23408 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23409 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23410 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
23414 Instead of the obsolete
23415 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
23416 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
23417 the same way, we promise.
23421 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
23423 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23424 customizing the group parameters or the
23425 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23426 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23427 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23428 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23429 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23433 Instead of the obsolete
23434 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
23435 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
23436 the same way, we promise.
23440 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
23441 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
23442 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
23443 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
23444 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
23446 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
23447 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
23448 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
23449 Emacs regular expression syntax.
23451 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
23452 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
23453 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
23454 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
23455 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
23456 @file{blacklist} respectively.
23458 @node BBDB Whitelists
23459 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
23460 @cindex spam filtering
23461 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
23462 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
23465 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
23467 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23468 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
23469 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
23470 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
23471 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23472 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
23473 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23477 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
23479 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
23480 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23481 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
23482 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
23483 classified as spammers.
23487 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
23489 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23490 customizing the group parameters or the
23491 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23492 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23493 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23494 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23495 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23499 Instead of the obsolete
23500 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
23501 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
23502 the same way, we promise.
23506 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
23507 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
23508 @cindex spam reporting
23509 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23510 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23513 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
23515 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23516 customizing the group parameters or the
23517 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23518 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23519 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
23522 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
23526 Instead of the obsolete
23527 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
23528 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
23529 same way, we promise.
23533 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
23535 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
23536 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
23537 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
23538 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
23539 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
23544 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23545 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23546 @cindex spam filtering
23547 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
23550 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
23552 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23553 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
23554 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
23555 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
23556 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
23557 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
23558 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
23564 @subsubsection Blackholes
23565 @cindex spam filtering
23566 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
23569 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
23571 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
23572 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
23573 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
23574 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
23575 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
23576 contains outdated servers.
23578 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
23579 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
23580 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
23581 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
23582 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
23583 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
23587 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
23589 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
23593 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
23595 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
23596 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
23600 @defvar spam-use-dig
23602 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
23603 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
23607 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
23608 ham processor for blackholes.
23610 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
23611 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
23612 @cindex spam filtering
23613 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
23616 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
23618 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
23619 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
23620 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
23621 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
23622 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
23623 message is spam or ham, respectively.
23627 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
23629 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23630 the message, positively identify it as spam.
23634 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
23636 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23637 the message, positively identify it as ham.
23641 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
23642 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
23645 @subsubsection Bogofilter
23646 @cindex spam filtering
23647 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
23650 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
23652 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23655 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
23656 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
23657 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
23658 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
23659 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
23660 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
23662 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
23663 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
23666 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
23667 processing will be turned off.
23669 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
23673 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
23675 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23676 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
23677 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
23678 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
23679 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
23680 installation documents for details.
23682 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
23686 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
23687 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23688 customizing the group parameters or the
23689 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23690 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
23691 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
23695 Instead of the obsolete
23696 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23697 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23698 the same way, we promise.
23701 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
23702 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23703 customizing the group parameters or the
23704 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23705 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23706 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
23707 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23708 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23712 Instead of the obsolete
23713 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23714 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23715 the same way, we promise.
23718 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
23720 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
23721 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
23722 database directory.
23726 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
23727 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23728 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
23729 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
23730 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
23731 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
23733 @node ifile spam filtering
23734 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
23735 @cindex spam filtering
23736 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
23739 @defvar spam-use-ifile
23741 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
23742 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
23746 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
23748 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
23749 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
23750 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
23754 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
23756 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
23757 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
23758 the default value of @samp{spam}.
23761 @defvar spam-ifile-database-path
23763 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
23764 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
23768 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
23769 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23770 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
23771 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
23774 @node spam-stat spam filtering
23775 @subsubsection spam-stat spam filtering
23776 @cindex spam filtering
23777 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
23781 @xref{Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat}.
23783 @defvar spam-use-stat
23785 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use
23786 spam-stat.el, an Emacs Lisp statistical analyzer.
23790 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
23791 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23792 customizing the group parameters or the
23793 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23794 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23795 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
23799 Instead of the obsolete
23800 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23801 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23802 the same way, we promise.
23805 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
23806 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23807 customizing the group parameters or the
23808 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23809 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23810 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
23811 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23812 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23816 Instead of the obsolete
23817 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23818 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23819 the same way, we promise.
23822 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
23823 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
23824 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
23825 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
23826 @code{spam-split} are provided.
23829 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
23830 @cindex spam filtering
23834 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
23835 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
23836 installed separately.
23838 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
23839 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
23840 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
23841 mail as a spam mail or not.
23843 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
23844 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
23845 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
23847 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Filtering Spam
23848 Using The Spam ELisp Package}) call SpamOracle.
23850 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
23851 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
23852 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
23853 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy} as described in
23854 the section @xref{Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package}. In
23855 this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is filtered using
23856 SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be moved to
23857 @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham messages stay
23861 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
23862 spam-split-group "Junk"
23863 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
23864 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23865 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
23868 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
23869 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
23873 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
23874 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
23875 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
23879 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
23880 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
23881 store its analyses. This is controlled by the variable
23882 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
23883 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
23884 database to live somewhere special, set
23885 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
23888 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
23889 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
23890 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns the
23891 characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
23892 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
23893 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary buffer
23894 and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using @file{spam.el}'s
23895 spam- and ham-processors, which is much more convenient. For a
23896 detailed description of spam- and ham-processors, @xref{Filtering Spam
23897 Using The Spam ELisp Package}.
23899 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
23900 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23901 customizing the group parameter or the
23902 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23903 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
23904 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
23908 Instead of the obsolete
23909 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23910 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23911 the same way, we promise.
23914 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
23915 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23916 customizing the group parameter or the
23917 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23918 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
23919 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
23920 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
23921 @emph{unclassified} groups.
23925 Instead of the obsolete
23926 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23927 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23928 the same way, we promise.
23931 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
23932 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
23935 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
23936 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
23937 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
23939 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
23940 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
23941 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
23942 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
23943 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
23944 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
23946 @node Extending the Spam ELisp package
23947 @subsubsection Extending the Spam ELisp package
23948 @cindex spam filtering
23949 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
23950 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
23952 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
23953 incoming mail, provide the following:
23961 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
23962 "True if blackbox should be used.")
23967 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
23969 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
23973 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
23974 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
23977 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
23981 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
23983 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
23987 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
23988 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
23989 start, or other restister/unregister routines more appropriate to
23995 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
23996 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
23997 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
23998 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
23999 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
24001 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
24002 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
24003 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
24007 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
24014 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
24015 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
24017 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
24018 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
24019 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
24020 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
24023 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
24024 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
24025 Only applicable to spam groups.")
24027 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
24028 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
24029 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
24038 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
24039 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
24041 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
24042 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
24043 variable customization.
24047 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
24049 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
24055 @node Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
24056 @subsection Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
24057 @cindex Paul Graham
24058 @cindex Graham, Paul
24059 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
24060 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
24061 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
24063 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
24064 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
24065 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
24066 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
24067 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
24068 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
24069 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
24070 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
24071 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
24074 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
24075 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
24076 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
24077 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
24078 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
24079 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
24080 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
24081 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
24083 Gnus supports this kind of filtering. But it needs some setting up.
24084 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
24085 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
24086 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
24087 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
24090 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
24091 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
24092 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
24095 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24096 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24098 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
24099 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
24100 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
24101 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
24102 need several hundred emails in both collections.
24104 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
24105 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
24106 per mail. Use the following:
24108 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
24109 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
24110 is treated as one spam mail.
24113 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
24114 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
24115 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
24118 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
24119 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds
24120 the the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
24121 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
24122 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds the the group
24123 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
24125 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
24126 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
24127 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
24128 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
24129 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
24132 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
24133 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
24134 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
24135 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
24138 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24139 reset the dictionary.
24141 @defun spam-stat-reset
24142 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24145 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24146 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24147 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24148 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24149 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24150 only non-spam mails.
24152 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24153 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24154 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24157 @defun spam-stat-save
24158 Save the dictionary.
24161 @defvar spam-stat-file
24162 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24163 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24166 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24167 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24169 In order to use @code{spam-stat} to split your mail, you need to add the
24170 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24173 (require 'spam-stat)
24177 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24180 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24181 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24182 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24183 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24185 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24186 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24187 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24188 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24191 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24192 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24196 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24197 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24200 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24201 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24202 expression are considered potential spam.
24205 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24206 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24207 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24211 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24212 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24213 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24214 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24215 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24218 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24219 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24220 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24224 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24225 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24226 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24227 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24228 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24232 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24233 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24234 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24235 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24240 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24241 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24243 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24245 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24246 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24247 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24250 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24251 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24252 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24255 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24256 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24257 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24258 already been processed as non-spam.
24261 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24262 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24263 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24264 been processed as spam.
24267 @defun spam-stat-save
24268 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24269 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24272 @defun spam-stat-load
24273 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24274 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24277 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24278 Return the spam score for a word.
24281 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24282 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24285 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24286 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24287 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24290 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24291 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24294 (require 'spam-stat)
24298 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24301 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24302 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24303 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24304 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24305 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24306 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24307 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24308 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24309 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24310 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24311 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24312 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24313 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24314 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24317 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
24320 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24321 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24322 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24323 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
24324 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24325 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24329 @section Interaction with other modes
24334 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provided some useful functions for dired
24335 buffers. It is enabled with
24337 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
24342 @findex gnus-dired-attach
24343 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
24344 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
24347 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
24348 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
24349 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
24353 @findex gnus-dired-print
24354 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
24355 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
24358 @node Various Various
24359 @section Various Various
24365 @item gnus-home-directory
24366 @vindex gnus-home-directory
24367 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
24368 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
24370 @item gnus-directory
24371 @vindex gnus-directory
24372 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
24373 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
24374 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
24376 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
24377 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
24378 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
24379 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
24381 @item gnus-default-directory
24382 @vindex gnus-default-directory
24383 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
24384 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
24385 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
24386 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
24387 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
24388 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
24391 @vindex gnus-verbose
24392 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
24393 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
24394 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
24395 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
24396 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
24398 @item gnus-verbose-backends
24399 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
24400 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
24401 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
24403 @item nnheader-max-head-length
24404 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
24405 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
24406 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
24407 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
24408 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
24409 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
24410 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
24411 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
24412 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
24414 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
24415 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
24416 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
24417 read when doing the operation described above.
24419 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24420 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24422 @cindex invalid characters in file names
24423 @cindex characters in file names
24424 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
24425 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
24426 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
24430 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24435 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
24436 Windows (phooey) systems.
24438 @item gnus-hidden-properties
24439 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
24440 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
24441 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
24442 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
24444 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
24445 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
24446 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
24447 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
24448 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
24450 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
24451 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
24452 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
24454 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24455 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24457 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
24458 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
24459 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
24460 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
24463 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
24471 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
24472 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
24474 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
24476 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
24482 Not because of victories @*
24485 but for the common sunshine,@*
24487 the largess of the spring.
24491 but for the day's work done@*
24492 as well as I was able;@*
24493 not for a seat upon the dais@*
24494 but at the common table.@*
24499 @chapter Appendices
24502 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
24503 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
24504 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
24505 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
24506 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
24507 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
24508 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
24509 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
24510 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
24517 @cindex installing under XEmacs
24519 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
24520 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
24521 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
24522 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
24523 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
24524 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
24531 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
24532 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
24534 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
24535 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
24536 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
24537 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
24538 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
24540 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
24541 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
24542 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
24543 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
24544 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
24545 appropriate name, don't you think?)
24547 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
24548 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
24549 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
24550 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
24553 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
24554 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
24555 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
24556 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
24557 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
24558 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
24559 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
24560 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
24561 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
24565 @node Gnus Versions
24566 @subsection Gnus Versions
24568 @cindex September Gnus
24570 @cindex Quassia Gnus
24571 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
24574 @cindex Gnus versions
24576 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
24577 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
24578 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
24580 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
24581 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
24583 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
24584 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
24586 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
24587 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
24589 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
24590 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
24593 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
24594 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
24596 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
24598 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
24599 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
24600 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'' -- don't panic.
24601 Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever
24602 you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach.
24603 Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
24606 @node Other Gnus Versions
24607 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
24610 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
24611 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
24612 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
24613 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
24615 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
24616 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
24617 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
24618 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
24625 What's the point of Gnus?
24627 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
24628 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
24629 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
24630 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
24631 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
24632 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
24633 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
24634 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
24635 keep track of millions of people who post?
24637 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
24638 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
24639 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
24640 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
24641 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
24642 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
24643 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
24644 every one of you to explore and invent.
24646 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
24647 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
24650 @node Compatibility
24651 @subsection Compatibility
24653 @cindex compatibility
24654 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
24655 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
24656 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
24661 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
24665 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
24668 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
24671 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
24672 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
24673 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
24674 important variables have their values copied into their global
24675 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
24676 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
24678 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
24679 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
24680 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
24681 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
24682 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
24686 @cindex highlighting
24687 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
24688 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
24689 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
24690 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
24691 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
24692 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
24695 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
24696 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
24697 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
24698 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
24700 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
24701 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
24702 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
24703 to stop doing it the old way.
24705 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
24707 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
24709 @cindex reporting bugs
24711 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
24712 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
24713 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
24715 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
24716 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
24717 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
24718 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
24723 @subsection Conformity
24725 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
24726 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
24734 There are no known breaches of this standard.
24738 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
24740 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
24741 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
24742 We do have some breaches to this one.
24748 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
24749 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
24750 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
24751 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
24752 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
24757 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
24758 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
24759 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
24760 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
24762 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
24763 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
24764 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
24766 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
24767 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
24769 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
24772 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
24773 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
24774 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
24775 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
24776 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
24779 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
24780 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
24781 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RF 1991/2440 format.
24782 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
24784 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
24785 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
24787 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
24788 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
24789 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
24790 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
24791 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
24792 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
24793 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
24794 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
24798 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
24799 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
24804 @subsection Emacsen
24810 Gnus should work on:
24818 XEmacs 21.1 and up.
24822 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
24823 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
24826 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
24827 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
24828 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
24832 @node Gnus Development
24833 @subsection Gnus Development
24835 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
24836 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
24837 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
24838 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
24839 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
24840 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
24841 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
24842 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
24844 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
24845 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
24846 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
24847 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
24848 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
24851 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
24852 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
24853 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
24854 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
24855 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
24857 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
24858 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
24859 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
24860 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
24861 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
24862 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
24863 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
24864 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
24865 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
24866 can't be assumed to do so.
24871 @subsection Contributors
24872 @cindex contributors
24874 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
24875 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
24876 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
24877 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
24878 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
24879 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
24880 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
24881 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
24882 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
24883 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
24885 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
24891 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
24894 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
24895 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
24896 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
24897 functionality and stuff.
24900 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
24901 well as numerous other things).
24904 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
24907 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
24910 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
24913 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
24916 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
24917 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
24920 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
24923 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
24924 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
24927 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
24930 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
24933 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
24936 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
24939 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
24940 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
24943 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
24946 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
24949 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
24952 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
24956 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
24959 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
24962 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
24965 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
24966 well as autoconf support.
24970 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
24971 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
24973 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
24988 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
24990 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
24994 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
25004 Alexei V. Barantsev,
25019 Massimo Campostrini,
25024 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
25025 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
25029 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
25032 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
25038 Michael Welsh Duggan,
25043 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
25047 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
25055 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
25057 Michelangelo Grigni,
25061 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
25063 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
25065 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
25072 François Felix Ingrand,
25073 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
25074 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
25076 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
25086 Peter Skov Knudsen,
25087 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
25089 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
25090 Thor Kristoffersen,
25093 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
25111 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
25112 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
25119 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
25124 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
25128 John McClary Prevost,
25134 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
25139 Christian von Roques,
25142 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25149 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25151 Randal L. Schwartz,
25165 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25170 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25190 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25191 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25192 (550kB and counting).
25194 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25197 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25198 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25202 @subsection New Features
25203 @cindex new features
25206 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25207 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25208 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25209 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25210 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25211 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25214 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25215 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25216 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25219 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25221 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25226 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25227 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25230 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25231 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25234 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25237 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25238 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25239 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25242 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25243 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25244 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25245 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25248 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25249 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25252 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25253 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25254 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25257 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25258 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25261 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25262 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25263 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25266 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25267 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25268 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25271 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25272 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25275 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25276 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25279 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25280 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25283 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25284 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25287 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25288 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25291 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25292 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25295 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25298 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25299 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25302 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25303 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
25306 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
25307 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25310 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
25313 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
25314 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25317 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
25321 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
25325 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
25326 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
25329 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
25335 @node September Gnus
25336 @subsubsection September Gnus
25340 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
25344 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
25349 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
25350 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
25354 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
25355 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
25359 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
25363 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
25364 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
25367 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
25371 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25374 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
25377 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
25380 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
25384 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
25385 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
25388 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
25392 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
25396 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
25400 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
25404 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
25407 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
25408 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
25411 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
25415 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
25416 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
25419 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
25422 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
25423 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
25424 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25427 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
25431 The Gnus cache is much faster.
25434 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
25438 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
25439 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
25442 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
25443 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
25446 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
25447 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
25450 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
25451 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
25452 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
25455 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
25456 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
25459 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
25462 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25465 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
25468 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
25471 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
25472 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
25475 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
25479 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
25482 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
25487 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
25490 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
25494 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25497 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
25501 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
25504 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
25507 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
25508 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25511 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
25512 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
25516 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
25517 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
25520 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
25524 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
25525 buffer to allow easier treatment.
25528 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
25531 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
25535 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
25539 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
25540 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
25543 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
25547 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
25548 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25551 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
25552 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25555 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
25559 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25562 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
25565 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
25571 @subsubsection Red Gnus
25573 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
25577 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
25584 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
25587 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
25588 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25591 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
25592 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
25596 Article washing status can be displayed in the
25597 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
25600 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
25603 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
25604 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
25607 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
25611 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
25612 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
25616 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
25617 Server Internals}).
25620 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
25624 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
25627 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
25628 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
25631 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
25632 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
25633 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
25636 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
25637 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25640 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
25641 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
25644 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
25648 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
25649 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25652 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
25653 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25656 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
25660 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
25663 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
25667 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
25668 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25671 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
25672 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25675 A new command for reading collections of documents
25676 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
25677 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
25680 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
25684 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
25685 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
25688 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
25689 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
25690 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
25693 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
25694 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
25698 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
25702 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
25706 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
25711 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
25715 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
25719 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
25720 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
25723 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
25729 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
25731 New features in Gnus 5.6:
25736 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
25737 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
25738 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
25741 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
25742 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
25743 group, which is created automatically.
25746 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
25750 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
25753 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
25754 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
25757 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
25761 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
25764 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
25765 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
25768 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
25771 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
25775 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
25776 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
25779 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
25780 control over simplification.
25783 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
25786 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
25790 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
25793 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
25796 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
25797 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
25798 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
25801 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
25802 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
25805 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
25809 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
25810 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
25813 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
25814 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
25817 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
25821 A history of where mails have been split is available.
25824 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
25827 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
25828 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
25831 A new function for citing in Message has been
25832 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
25835 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
25838 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
25842 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
25843 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
25846 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
25847 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
25850 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
25853 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
25857 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
25858 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
25860 New features in Gnus 5.8:
25865 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
25866 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
25868 If you used procmail like in
25871 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
25872 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
25873 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
25874 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
25877 this now has changed to
25881 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
25885 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
25888 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
25889 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
25892 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
25893 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
25896 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
25897 called to position point.
25900 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
25901 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
25904 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
25905 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
25908 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
25909 subtly different manner.
25912 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
25913 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
25914 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
25917 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
25922 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
25925 New features in Gnus 5.10:
25930 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
25931 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
25932 region if the region is active.
25935 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
25939 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
25940 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
25943 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
25944 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
25947 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
25949 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
25950 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
25951 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
25952 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
25953 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
25954 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
25955 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
25956 isn't save in general.
25961 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
25962 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
25963 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
25964 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
25969 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
25970 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
25971 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
25975 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
25978 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
25983 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
25984 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
25986 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
25987 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
25991 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
25992 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
25995 Retrieval of charters and control messages
25997 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
25998 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
26003 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
26004 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
26005 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
26008 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
26009 decompressed when activated.
26012 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
26013 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
26016 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
26019 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
26020 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
26023 Warn about email replies to news
26025 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
26026 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
26030 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
26031 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
26035 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
26036 opposed to old but unread messages).
26039 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
26040 Gcc articles as read.
26043 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
26046 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
26047 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
26050 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
26051 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
26054 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
26055 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
26058 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
26059 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
26062 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
26064 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
26065 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
26066 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
26067 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
26070 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
26072 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
26073 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
26074 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
26075 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
26076 the second parameter.
26078 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
26079 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
26080 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
26081 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
26082 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
26083 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
26084 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
26085 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
26086 cycle used under Unix systems.
26088 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} superfluous, so it has
26092 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
26094 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
26095 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
26096 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
26097 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
26098 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
26102 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
26104 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
26105 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
26106 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
26107 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
26111 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
26113 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
26114 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
26115 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
26116 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
26118 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
26119 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
26120 message cited below.
26123 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
26126 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
26128 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
26129 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
26130 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
26131 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
26132 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
26135 (setq gnus-parameters
26137 (gnus-show-threads nil)
26138 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
26139 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
26140 (to-group . "\\1"))))
26144 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now iconized for Emacs too.
26146 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
26150 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
26152 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
26153 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
26154 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
26155 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
26156 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
26157 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
26158 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
26159 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
26160 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
26163 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
26165 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
26166 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
26167 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
26168 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
26169 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
26170 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
26173 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
26174 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
26178 Improved anti-spam features.
26180 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26181 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26182 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26183 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26184 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26187 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers.
26190 Face headers handling.
26193 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26194 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26197 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26200 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26202 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26203 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26204 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26205 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26206 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26207 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26208 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26209 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26210 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26213 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
26215 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
26216 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
26217 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
26218 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
26219 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
26220 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
26221 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
26222 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
26223 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
26224 was inserted directly.
26227 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26229 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26230 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26236 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
26237 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
26238 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
26239 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
26240 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
26241 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
26242 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
26243 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
26244 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
26245 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
26246 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
26247 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
26248 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
26249 is not needed any more.
26252 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26254 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26255 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26256 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26257 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26258 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26262 @file{deuglify.el} (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article})
26264 A new file from Raymond Scholz @email{rscholz@@zonix.de} for deuglifying
26265 broken Outlook (Express) articles.
26267 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
26268 @c CVS. We should find a better place for this item.
26270 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26272 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26273 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26274 lisp directory into load-path.
26276 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26277 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26280 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
26282 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
26285 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
26287 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
26288 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
26289 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
26290 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
26293 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
26295 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
26297 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
26298 'bbdb-complete-name)
26302 Externalizing and deleting of attachments.
26304 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
26305 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
26306 local files as external parts.
26308 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26309 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26310 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26311 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26312 that support editing.
26315 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26317 The default value is determined from the
26318 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26319 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26320 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26323 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
26325 Add a new format of match like
26327 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
26328 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26330 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
26332 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
26333 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26337 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
26339 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
26340 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
26341 need add those two headers too.
26344 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
26346 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
26347 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
26348 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
26351 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
26352 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
26353 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
26357 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
26358 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
26359 inline PGP signed messages. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
26362 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
26364 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
26367 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
26369 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
26372 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26374 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26375 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26376 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26379 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
26381 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
26385 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
26387 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
26388 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
26389 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
26390 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
26391 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
26392 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
26393 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
26394 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
26397 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26399 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26400 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26401 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26402 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26403 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26406 Extended format specs.
26408 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26409 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26410 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26411 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26412 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26413 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26416 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26418 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26419 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26420 out other articles.
26423 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26425 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26426 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26427 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26428 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26431 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26433 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26434 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26435 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26438 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
26440 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
26441 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
26442 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
26443 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
26444 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
26445 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
26446 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
26447 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
26448 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
26449 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
26450 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
26453 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
26454 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
26457 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
26458 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
26459 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
26460 message, Message Manual}).
26463 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26464 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26466 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26467 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26468 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26470 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26474 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
26475 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
26477 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
26478 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
26479 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
26480 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
26483 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26486 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
26489 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
26490 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
26493 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to symbol @code{best}.
26495 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
26496 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
26497 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
26498 invalidate the digital signature.
26505 @section The Manual
26509 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
26510 either @code{texi2dvi}
26512 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
26513 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
26515 to get what you hold in your hands now.
26517 The following conventions have been used:
26522 This is a @samp{string}
26525 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
26528 This is a @file{file}
26531 This is a @code{symbol}
26535 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
26539 (setq flargnoze "yes")
26542 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
26545 (setq flumphel 'yes)
26548 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
26549 ever get them confused.
26553 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
26554 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
26555 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
26556 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
26557 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
26558 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
26559 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
26565 @node On Writing Manuals
26566 @section On Writing Manuals
26568 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
26569 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
26570 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
26571 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
26572 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
26573 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
26576 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
26577 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
26578 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
26581 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
26582 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
26587 @section Terminology
26589 @cindex terminology
26594 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
26595 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
26596 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
26597 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
26598 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
26602 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
26603 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
26604 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
26605 not posting, and replying is not following up.
26609 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
26613 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
26618 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
26619 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
26620 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
26621 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
26622 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
26623 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
26624 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
26625 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
26626 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
26629 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
26630 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
26631 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
26632 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
26633 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
26634 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
26636 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
26637 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
26638 access the articles.
26640 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
26641 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
26642 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
26647 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
26648 default, way of getting news.
26652 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
26653 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
26658 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
26659 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
26663 A message that has been posted as news.
26666 @cindex mail message
26667 A message that has been mailed.
26671 A mail message or news article
26675 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
26680 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
26685 A line from the head of an article.
26689 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
26690 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
26692 @item @acronym{NOV}
26693 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
26694 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
26695 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
26696 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
26697 normal @sc{head} format.
26701 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
26702 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
26703 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
26704 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
26705 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
26706 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
26708 @item killed groups
26709 @cindex killed groups
26710 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
26711 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
26713 @item zombie groups
26714 @cindex zombie groups
26715 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
26718 @cindex active file
26719 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
26720 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
26721 is rather large, as you might surmise.
26724 @cindex bogus groups
26725 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
26726 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
26727 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
26730 @cindex activating groups
26731 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
26732 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
26733 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
26737 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
26738 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
26739 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
26743 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
26745 @item select method
26746 @cindex select method
26747 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
26750 @item virtual server
26751 @cindex virtual server
26752 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
26753 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
26754 whole is a virtual server.
26758 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
26759 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
26762 @item ephemeral groups
26763 @cindex ephemeral groups
26764 @cindex temporary groups
26765 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
26766 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
26767 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
26770 @cindex solid groups
26771 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
26772 group buffer are solid groups.
26774 @item sparse articles
26775 @cindex sparse articles
26776 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
26777 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
26781 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
26782 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
26786 @cindex thread root
26787 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
26788 articles in the thread.
26792 An article that has responses.
26796 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
26800 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
26801 specified by RFC 1153.
26804 @cindex splitting, terminolgy
26805 @cindex mail sorting
26806 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
26807 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
26808 incorrectly called mail filtering.
26814 @node Customization
26815 @section Customization
26816 @cindex general customization
26818 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
26819 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
26820 for some quite common situations.
26823 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
26824 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
26825 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
26826 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
26830 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
26831 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
26833 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
26834 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
26835 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
26839 @item gnus-read-active-file
26840 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
26841 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
26842 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26843 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
26844 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
26846 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
26847 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
26848 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
26849 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
26853 @node Slow Terminal Connection
26854 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
26856 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
26857 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
26858 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
26862 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
26863 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
26864 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
26865 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
26866 horizontal and vertical recentering.
26868 @item gnus-visible-headers
26869 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
26870 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
26871 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
26872 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
26874 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
26876 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
26877 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
26878 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
26881 @item gnus-use-full-window
26882 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
26883 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
26884 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
26885 want to read them anyway.
26887 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
26888 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
26892 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
26893 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
26894 lines, which might save some time.
26898 @node Little Disk Space
26899 @subsection Little Disk Space
26902 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
26903 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
26907 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
26908 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
26909 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26910 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26913 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
26914 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
26915 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26916 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26919 @item gnus-save-killed-list
26920 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
26921 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
26922 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
26923 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
26929 @subsection Slow Machine
26930 @cindex slow machine
26932 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
26933 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
26935 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26936 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
26938 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
26939 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
26940 summary buffer faster.
26944 @node Troubleshooting
26945 @section Troubleshooting
26946 @cindex troubleshooting
26948 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
26956 Make sure your computer is switched on.
26959 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
26960 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
26964 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
26965 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
26966 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
26969 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
26970 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
26973 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
26974 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
26975 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
26976 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
26977 something like that.
26980 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
26983 @cindex reporting bugs
26985 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26987 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
26988 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
26989 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
26990 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
26992 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
26993 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
26994 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
26995 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
26998 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
26999 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
27000 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
27001 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
27002 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
27003 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
27005 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
27006 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
27007 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
27011 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
27012 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
27015 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
27016 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
27017 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
27018 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
27019 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
27020 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
27021 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
27022 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
27023 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
27024 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
27025 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
27026 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
27027 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
27028 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
27033 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
27034 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
27035 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
27036 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
27037 helps isolating the real problem areas).
27039 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
27040 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
27041 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
27042 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
27043 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
27044 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
27045 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
27046 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
27047 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
27048 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
27049 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
27050 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
27051 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
27054 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
27055 @cindex ding mailing list
27056 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
27057 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
27058 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
27059 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
27063 @node Gnus Reference Guide
27064 @section Gnus Reference Guide
27066 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
27067 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
27068 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
27069 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
27072 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
27073 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
27074 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
27075 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
27076 and general methods of operation.
27079 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
27080 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
27081 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
27082 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
27083 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
27084 * Group Info:: The group info format.
27085 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
27086 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
27087 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
27091 @node Gnus Utility Functions
27092 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
27093 @cindex Gnus utility functions
27094 @cindex utility functions
27096 @cindex internal variables
27098 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
27099 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
27100 Below is a list of the most common ones.
27104 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
27105 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
27106 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
27108 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
27109 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
27110 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
27112 @item gnus-group-real-name
27113 @findex gnus-group-real-name
27114 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
27117 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
27118 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
27119 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
27120 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
27122 @item gnus-get-info
27123 @findex gnus-get-info
27124 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
27126 @item gnus-group-unread
27127 @findex gnus-group-unread
27128 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
27132 @findex gnus-active
27133 The active entry for @var{group}.
27135 @item gnus-set-active
27136 @findex gnus-set-active
27137 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
27139 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27140 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27141 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
27144 @item gnus-continuum-version
27145 @findex gnus-continuum-version
27146 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
27147 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
27150 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
27151 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
27152 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
27154 @item gnus-news-group-p
27155 @findex gnus-news-group-p
27156 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
27158 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27159 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27160 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
27162 @item gnus-server-to-method
27163 @findex gnus-server-to-method
27164 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
27166 @item gnus-server-equal
27167 @findex gnus-server-equal
27168 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
27170 @item gnus-group-native-p
27171 @findex gnus-group-native-p
27172 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
27174 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
27175 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
27176 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
27178 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
27179 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
27180 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
27182 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
27183 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
27184 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
27185 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
27187 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
27188 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
27189 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
27191 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
27192 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
27193 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
27195 @item gnus-check-backend-function
27196 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
27197 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
27198 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
27201 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
27205 @item gnus-read-method
27206 @findex gnus-read-method
27207 Prompts the user for a select method.
27212 @node Back End Interface
27213 @subsection Back End Interface
27215 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
27216 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
27217 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
27218 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
27219 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
27220 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
27222 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
27223 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
27224 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
27225 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
27226 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
27227 been opened, the function should fail.
27229 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
27230 name. Take this example:
27234 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
27235 (nntp-port-number 4324))
27238 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
27239 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
27241 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
27242 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
27243 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
27245 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
27246 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
27247 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
27249 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
27250 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
27251 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
27252 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
27253 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
27254 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
27257 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
27258 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
27259 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
27260 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
27263 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
27264 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
27265 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
27266 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
27267 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
27268 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
27269 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
27270 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
27271 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
27272 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
27274 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
27275 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
27276 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
27277 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
27278 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
27279 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
27280 of numbers as long as possible.
27282 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
27283 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
27284 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
27286 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
27289 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
27292 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
27293 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
27294 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
27295 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
27296 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
27297 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
27301 @node Required Back End Functions
27302 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
27306 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
27308 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
27309 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
27310 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
27311 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
27313 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
27314 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
27315 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
27316 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
27318 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
27319 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
27320 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
27321 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
27322 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
27323 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
27324 number, do maximum fetches.
27326 Here's an example HEAD:
27329 221 1056 Article retrieved.
27330 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
27331 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
27332 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
27333 Subject: Re: Something very droll
27334 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
27335 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
27337 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
27338 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
27339 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
27343 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
27344 these in the data buffer.
27346 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
27350 head = error / valid-head
27351 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
27352 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
27353 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
27354 header = <text> eol
27358 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
27360 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
27361 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
27365 nov-buffer = *nov-line
27366 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
27367 field = <text except TAB>
27370 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
27374 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
27376 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
27377 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
27379 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
27380 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
27381 server. In fact, it should do so.
27383 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
27384 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
27387 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
27389 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
27390 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
27393 There should be no data returned.
27396 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
27398 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
27399 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
27400 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
27401 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
27403 There should be no data returned.
27406 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
27408 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
27409 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
27410 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
27411 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
27413 There should be no data returned.
27416 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
27418 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
27420 There should be no data returned.
27423 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
27425 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
27426 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
27427 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
27428 it would be nice if that were possible.
27430 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
27431 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
27432 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
27433 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
27434 into its article buffer.
27436 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
27437 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
27438 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
27439 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
27440 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
27441 on successful article retrieval.
27444 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
27446 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
27447 making @var{group} the current group.
27449 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
27452 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
27455 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
27458 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
27459 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
27460 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
27461 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
27462 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
27463 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
27464 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
27465 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
27466 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
27470 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
27471 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
27472 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
27476 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27478 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
27479 a no-op on most back ends.
27481 There should be no data returned.
27484 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
27486 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
27489 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
27492 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
27493 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
27496 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
27497 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
27498 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
27499 and the highest as 0.
27502 active-file = *active-line
27503 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
27505 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
27508 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
27509 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
27510 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
27513 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
27515 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
27516 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
27517 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
27518 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
27519 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
27520 clear if the posting could not be completed.
27522 There should be no result data from this function.
27527 @node Optional Back End Functions
27528 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
27532 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
27534 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
27535 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
27536 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
27538 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
27539 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
27540 former is in the same format as the data from
27541 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
27542 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
27545 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
27549 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
27551 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
27552 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
27553 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
27554 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
27555 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
27557 There should be no result data from this function.
27560 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
27562 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
27563 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
27564 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
27565 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
27566 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
27567 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
27568 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
27569 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
27571 There should be no result data from this function.
27574 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
27576 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
27577 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
27578 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
27579 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
27580 propagate the mark information to the server.
27582 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
27585 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
27588 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
27589 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
27590 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
27591 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
27592 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
27593 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
27594 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
27595 possible, not limit itself to these.
27597 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
27598 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
27599 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
27600 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
27602 An example action list:
27605 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
27606 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
27607 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
27610 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
27611 mark on (currently not used for anything).
27613 There should be no result data from this function.
27615 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
27617 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
27618 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
27619 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
27620 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
27621 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
27623 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
27624 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
27625 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
27628 There should be no result data from this function.
27631 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
27633 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
27634 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
27635 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
27636 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
27637 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
27638 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
27639 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
27640 local if that's practical.
27642 There should be no result data from this function.
27645 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
27647 The result data from this function should be a description of
27651 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
27653 description = <text>
27656 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
27658 The result data from this function should be the description of all
27659 groups available on the server.
27662 description-buffer = *description-line
27666 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
27668 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
27669 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
27670 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
27671 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
27672 in the active buffer format.
27674 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
27675 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
27676 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
27677 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
27678 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
27679 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
27680 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
27683 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27685 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
27687 There should be no return data.
27690 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
27692 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
27693 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
27694 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
27695 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
27696 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
27699 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
27702 There should be no result data returned.
27705 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
27707 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
27708 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
27710 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
27711 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
27712 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
27713 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
27714 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
27715 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
27717 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
27718 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
27721 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27722 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27724 There should be no data returned.
27727 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
27729 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
27730 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
27731 this function in short order.
27733 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27734 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27736 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
27737 article for that group.
27739 There should be no data returned.
27742 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
27744 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
27745 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
27747 There should be no data returned.
27750 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
27752 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
27753 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
27754 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
27756 There should be no data returned.
27759 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
27761 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
27762 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
27764 There should be no data returned.
27769 @node Error Messaging
27770 @subsubsection Error Messaging
27772 @findex nnheader-report
27773 @findex nnheader-get-report
27774 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
27775 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
27776 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
27777 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
27778 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
27779 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
27782 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
27784 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
27787 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
27788 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
27789 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
27790 takes one argument---the server symbol.
27792 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
27793 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
27794 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
27797 @node Writing New Back Ends
27798 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
27800 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
27801 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
27802 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
27803 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
27804 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
27807 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
27808 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
27809 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
27811 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
27812 package called @code{nnoo}.
27814 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
27815 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
27821 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
27822 parameters. For instance:
27825 (nnoo-declare nndir
27829 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
27830 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
27833 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
27834 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
27835 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
27837 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
27838 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
27839 a function in those back ends.
27842 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27843 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27844 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27847 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
27848 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
27849 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
27851 @item nnoo-define-basics
27852 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
27856 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27860 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
27861 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
27862 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
27864 @item nnoo-map-functions
27865 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
27866 functions from the parent back ends.
27869 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27870 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27871 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
27874 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
27875 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
27876 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
27877 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
27880 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
27881 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
27882 haven't already been defined.
27888 nnmh-request-newgroups)
27892 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
27893 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
27894 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
27899 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
27902 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
27903 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
27907 (require 'nnheader)
27911 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
27913 (nnoo-declare nndir
27916 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27917 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27918 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27920 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
27921 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
27924 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
27926 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
27927 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
27928 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
27930 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
27931 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
27933 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
27935 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27937 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
27938 (setq nndir-directory
27939 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
27941 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
27942 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
27943 (push `(nndir-current-group
27944 ,(file-name-nondirectory
27945 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27947 (push `(nndir-top-directory
27948 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27950 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
27952 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27953 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27954 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27955 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
27956 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
27960 nnmh-status-message
27962 nnmh-request-newgroups))
27968 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27969 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27971 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
27972 @findex gnus-declare-backend
27973 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
27974 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
27975 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
27977 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
27978 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
27983 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
27986 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
27988 The abilities can be:
27992 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
27994 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
27996 This back end supports both mail and news.
27998 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
28001 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
28002 articles and groups.
28004 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
28005 true for almost all back ends.
28006 @item prompt-address
28007 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
28008 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
28009 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
28013 @node Mail-like Back Ends
28014 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
28016 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
28017 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
28018 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
28019 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
28022 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
28023 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
28024 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
28027 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
28028 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
28031 This function takes four parameters.
28035 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
28038 @item exit-function
28039 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
28041 @item temp-directory
28042 Where the temporary files should be stored.
28045 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
28046 performed for one group only.
28049 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
28050 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
28051 find the article number assigned to this article.
28053 The function also uses the following variables:
28054 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
28055 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
28056 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
28057 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
28061 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
28062 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
28066 @node Score File Syntax
28067 @subsection Score File Syntax
28069 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
28070 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
28071 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
28073 Here's a typical score file:
28077 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
28084 BNF definition of a score file:
28087 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
28088 element = rule / atom
28089 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
28090 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
28091 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
28092 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
28094 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
28095 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
28096 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
28097 date-header = "date"
28098 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28099 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28100 score = "nil" / <integer>
28101 date = "nil" / <natural number>
28102 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
28103 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
28104 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
28105 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
28106 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28107 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28108 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
28109 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28110 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
28111 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
28112 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
28113 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
28114 exclude-files / read-only / touched
28115 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
28116 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
28117 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
28118 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
28119 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
28120 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
28121 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
28122 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
28123 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
28124 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
28125 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
28126 eval = "eval" space <form>
28127 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
28130 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
28133 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
28134 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
28135 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
28136 one looong line, then that's ok.
28138 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
28139 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
28143 @subsection Headers
28145 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
28146 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
28147 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
28148 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
28150 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
28151 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
28152 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
28153 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
28154 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
28155 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
28156 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
28158 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
28159 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
28160 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
28161 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
28162 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
28164 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
28165 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
28171 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
28172 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
28174 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
28175 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
28176 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
28177 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
28179 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
28183 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
28186 is transformed into
28189 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
28192 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
28193 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
28196 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
28199 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
28200 is slightly tricky:
28203 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
28209 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
28212 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
28218 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
28225 and is equal to the previous range.
28227 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
28228 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
28229 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
28233 range = simple-range / normal-range
28234 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
28235 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
28236 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
28237 number *[ " " contents ]
28240 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
28241 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
28242 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
28243 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
28244 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
28249 @subsection Group Info
28251 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
28252 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
28253 describes the group.
28255 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
28256 second is a more complex one:
28259 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
28261 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
28262 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
28264 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
28267 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
28268 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
28269 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
28270 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
28271 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
28272 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
28273 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
28274 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
28275 this section is about.
28277 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
28278 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
28279 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
28281 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
28284 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
28285 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
28286 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28287 group = quote <string> quote
28288 ralevel = rank / level
28289 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28290 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
28291 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28293 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
28294 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
28295 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
28296 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
28299 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
28300 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
28303 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
28304 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
28307 @item gnus-info-group
28308 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
28309 @findex gnus-info-group
28310 @findex gnus-info-set-group
28311 Get/set the group name.
28313 @item gnus-info-rank
28314 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
28315 @findex gnus-info-rank
28316 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
28317 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
28319 @item gnus-info-level
28320 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
28321 @findex gnus-info-level
28322 @findex gnus-info-set-level
28323 Get/set the group level.
28325 @item gnus-info-score
28326 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
28327 @findex gnus-info-score
28328 @findex gnus-info-set-score
28329 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
28331 @item gnus-info-read
28332 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
28333 @findex gnus-info-read
28334 @findex gnus-info-set-read
28335 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
28337 @item gnus-info-marks
28338 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
28339 @findex gnus-info-marks
28340 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
28341 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
28343 @item gnus-info-method
28344 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
28345 @findex gnus-info-method
28346 @findex gnus-info-set-method
28347 Get/set the group select method.
28349 @item gnus-info-params
28350 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
28351 @findex gnus-info-params
28352 @findex gnus-info-set-params
28353 Get/set the group parameters.
28356 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
28357 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
28359 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
28360 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
28361 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
28362 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
28365 @node Extended Interactive
28366 @subsection Extended Interactive
28367 @cindex interactive
28368 @findex gnus-interactive
28370 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
28371 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
28372 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
28375 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
28376 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
28381 The best thing to do would have been to implement
28382 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
28383 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
28384 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
28385 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
28386 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
28387 @code{interactive}.
28389 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
28394 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
28395 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
28399 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
28400 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
28401 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
28404 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
28408 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
28412 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
28418 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
28419 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
28423 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
28424 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
28425 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
28427 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
28428 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
28429 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
28430 Gnus, that's very useful.
28432 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
28433 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
28434 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
28435 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
28436 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
28437 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
28438 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
28439 following function:
28442 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
28446 (,function ,@@args))
28450 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
28451 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
28452 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
28455 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
28456 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
28457 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
28459 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
28460 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
28461 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
28464 @node Various File Formats
28465 @subsection Various File Formats
28468 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
28469 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
28473 @node Active File Format
28474 @subsubsection Active File Format
28476 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
28477 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
28480 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
28483 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
28484 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
28485 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
28486 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
28487 no.general 1000 900 y
28490 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
28493 active = *group-line
28494 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
28495 group = <non-white-space string>
28497 high-number = <non-negative integer>
28498 low-number = <positive integer>
28499 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
28502 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
28503 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
28506 @node Newsgroups File Format
28507 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
28509 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
28510 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
28511 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
28514 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
28515 Here's the definition:
28519 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
28520 group = <non-white-space string>
28522 description = <string>
28527 @node Emacs for Heathens
28528 @section Emacs for Heathens
28530 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
28531 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
28532 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
28533 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
28534 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
28535 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
28536 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
28540 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
28541 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
28546 @subsection Keystrokes
28550 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
28553 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
28556 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
28557 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
28558 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
28559 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
28560 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
28561 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
28563 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
28564 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
28565 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
28566 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
28567 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
28568 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
28569 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
28571 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
28572 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
28573 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
28574 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
28575 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
28576 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
28577 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
28579 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
28580 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
28581 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
28582 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
28583 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
28589 @subsection Emacs Lisp
28591 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
28592 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
28593 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
28594 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
28596 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
28597 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
28598 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
28599 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
28600 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
28601 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
28602 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
28603 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
28604 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
28605 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
28607 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
28608 write the following:
28611 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
28614 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
28615 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
28616 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
28617 change how Gnus works.
28619 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
28620 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
28621 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
28622 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
28623 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
28625 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
28626 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
28627 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
28631 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
28635 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
28638 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
28639 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
28642 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
28645 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
28646 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
28649 @include gnus-faq.texi
28669 @c Local Variables:
28671 @c coding: iso-8859-1
28675 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819